* exec.c (xfer_memory): Add attrib argument.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
29e57380 2@c Copyright 1988-2001
c906108c
SS
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c
5d161b24 5@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
6@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8@setfilename gdb.info
9@c
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c
c906108c 12@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
13@setchapternewpage odd
14@c %**end of header
15
16@iftex
17@c @smallbook
18@c @cropmarks
19@end iftex
20
21@finalout
22@syncodeindex ky cp
23
41afff9a 24@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 25@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 26@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 27@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
28
29@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
6d2ebf8b 30@set EDITION Eighth
c906108c
SS
31
32@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
6d2ebf8b 33@set DATE March 2000
c906108c 34
6d2ebf8b 35@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 36
c906108c 37@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 38@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
39@dircategory Programming & development tools.
40@direntry
c906108c 41* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
42@end direntry
43
c906108c
SS
44@ifinfo
45This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
46
47
5d161b24 48This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
49of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
50for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
51
6d2ebf8b 52Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c
SS
53
54Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
55this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
56are preserved on all copies.
57
58@ignore
59Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
60results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
61notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
62(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
63
64@end ignore
65Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
66manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
67entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
68permission notice identical to this one.
69
70Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
71into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
72@end ifinfo
73
74@titlepage
75@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
76@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 77@sp 1
c906108c
SS
78@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
79@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 80@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 81@page
c906108c
SS
82@tex
83{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 84\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
85\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
86\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
87}
88@end tex
53a5351d 89
c906108c 90@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
6d2ebf8b 91Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 92@sp 2
c906108c
SS
93Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9459 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
95Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b
SS
96ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
97
c906108c
SS
98Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
99this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
100are preserved on all copies.
101
102Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
103manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
104entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
105permission notice identical to this one.
106
107Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
108into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
109@end titlepage
110@page
111
b9deaee7 112@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
113@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
c906108c
SS
115@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
5d161b24 119This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
120@value{GDBVN}.
121
6d2ebf8b
SS
122Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124@menu
125* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
126* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
127
128* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
129* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
130* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
131* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
132* Stack:: Examining the stack
133* Source:: Examining source files
134* Data:: Examining data
135
136* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
137
138* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
139* Altering:: Altering execution
140* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
141* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
142* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
145* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
146* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 147* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
148
149* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
150* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
151
152* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
153* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
154* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
155* Index:: Index
156@end menu
157
b9deaee7 158@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
159
160@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
161
162@ifhtml
163@node Top
164
165@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
166
167This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
168
169This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
170@value{GDBVN}.
171
172Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
173
c906108c
SS
174@menu
175* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 176* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
177
178* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
179* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
180* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
181* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
182* Stack:: Examining the stack
183* Source:: Examining source files
184* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 185
7a292a7a 186* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
187
188* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
189* Altering:: Altering execution
190* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
191* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 192* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
193* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
194* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 195* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 196* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
c906108c
SS
197
198* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 199* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
200
201* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
202* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
203* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
204* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
205@end menu
206
6d2ebf8b
SS
207@end ifhtml
208
449f3b6c
AC
209@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
210@iftex
211@contents
212@end iftex
213
6d2ebf8b 214@node Summary
c906108c
SS
215@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
216
217The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
218going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
219program was doing at the moment it crashed.
220
221@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
222these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
223
224@itemize @bullet
225@item
226Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
227
228@item
229Make your program stop on specified conditions.
230
231@item
232Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
233
234@item
235Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
236effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
237@end itemize
238
cce74817 239You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 240For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
241For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
242
cce74817
JM
243@cindex Chill
244@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 245Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 246see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 247
cce74817
JM
248@cindex Pascal
249Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
250nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
251entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
252syntax.
c906108c 253
c906108c
SS
254@cindex Fortran
255@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 256it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 257underscore.
c906108c 258
c906108c
SS
259@menu
260* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
261* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
262@end menu
263
6d2ebf8b 264@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
265@unnumberedsec Free software
266
5d161b24 267@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
268General Public License
269(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
270program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
271freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
272the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
273Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
274Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
275
276Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
277you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
278from anyone else.
279
6d2ebf8b 280@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
281@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
282
283Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
284other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
285development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
286of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
287to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
288file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
289blow-by-blow account.
290
291Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
292
293@quotation
294@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
295or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
296omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
297@end quotation
298
299So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
300particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
301releases:
8c70017b 302Andrew Cagney (release 5.0);
c906108c
SS
303Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
304Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
305Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
306Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
307Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
308John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
309Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
310and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
311
312Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
313Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
314
96a2c332
SS
315Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in
316@value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
317Bothner. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on
318C++ was by Peter TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading
319to release 3.0).
c906108c
SS
320
321@value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
322object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
323Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
324
325David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
326the original support for encapsulated COFF.
327
96c405b3 328Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
329
330Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
331Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
332support.
333Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
334Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
335Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
336David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
337Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
338Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
339Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
340Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
341Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
342Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
343Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
344Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
345Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
346Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
347Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
348
349Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
350
351Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
352libraries.
353
354Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
355about several machine instruction sets.
356
357Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
358remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
359contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
360and RDI targets, respectively.
361
362Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
363command-line editing and command history.
364
7a292a7a
SS
365Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
366Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 367
5d161b24 368Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
c906108c
SS
369He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
370symbols.
c906108c
SS
371
372Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
373Super-H processors.
374
375NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
376
377Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
378
379Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
380
381Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
382
96a2c332 383Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
384
385Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
386watchpoints.
387
388Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
389
390Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
391
392Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 393nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
394
395The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
396support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
397(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
398compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
399John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
400Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
401information in this manual.
402
96a2c332
SS
403Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
404development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
405fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
406Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
407Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
408Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
409Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
410addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
411JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
412Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
413Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
414Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
415Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
416Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
417Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
418
419
6d2ebf8b 420@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
421@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
422
423You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
424However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
425debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
426
427@iftex
428In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
429to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
430@end iftex
431
432@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
433@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
434
435One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
436processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
437quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
438definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
439session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
440then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
441same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
442@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
443procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
444
445@smallexample
446$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
447$ @b{./m4}
448@b{define(foo,0000)}
449
450@b{foo}
4510000
452@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
453
454@b{bar}
4550000
456@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
457
458@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
459@b{baz}
460@b{C-d}
461m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
462@end smallexample
463
464@noindent
465Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
466
c906108c
SS
467@smallexample
468$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
469@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
470@c FIXME... format to come out better.
471@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 472 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 473 the conditions.
5d161b24 474There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
475 for details.
476
477@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
478(@value{GDBP})
479@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
480
481@noindent
482@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
483rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
484We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
485that examples fit in this manual.
486
487@smallexample
488(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
489@end smallexample
490
491@noindent
492We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
493Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
494@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
495@code{break} command.
496
497@smallexample
498(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
499Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
500@end smallexample
501
502@noindent
503Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
504control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
505subroutine, the program runs as usual:
506
507@smallexample
508(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
509Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
510@b{define(foo,0000)}
511
512@b{foo}
5130000
514@end smallexample
515
516@noindent
517To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
518suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
519context where it stops.
520
521@smallexample
522@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
523
5d161b24 524Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
525 at builtin.c:879
526879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
527@end smallexample
528
529@noindent
530Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
531the next line of the current function.
532
533@smallexample
534(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
535882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
536 : nil,
537@end smallexample
538
539@noindent
540@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
541by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
542@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
543subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
544
545@smallexample
546(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
547set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
548 at input.c:530
549530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
550@end smallexample
551
552@noindent
553The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
554suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
555shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
556command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
557in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
558stack frame for each active subroutine.
559
560@smallexample
561(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
562#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
563 at input.c:530
5d161b24 564#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
565 at builtin.c:882
566#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
567#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
568 at macro.c:71
569#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
570#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
571@end smallexample
572
573@noindent
574We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
575times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
576falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
577
578@smallexample
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5800x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
581(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5820x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
583def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
584(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
585536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
586 : xstrdup(rq);
587(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
588538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
589@end smallexample
590
591@noindent
592The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
593@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
594and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
595(@code{print}) to see their values.
596
597@smallexample
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
599$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
600(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
601$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
602@end smallexample
603
604@noindent
605@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
606To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
607surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
608
609@smallexample
610(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
611533 xfree(rquote);
612534
613535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
614 : xstrdup (lq);
615536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
616 : xstrdup (rq);
617537
618538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
619539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
620540 @}
621541
622542 void
623@end smallexample
624
625@noindent
626Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
627@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
628
629@smallexample
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
633540 @}
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
635$3 = 9
636(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
637$4 = 7
638@end smallexample
639
640@noindent
641That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
642@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
643@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
644the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
645any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
646assignments.
647
648@smallexample
649(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
650$5 = 7
651(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
652$6 = 9
653@end smallexample
654
655@noindent
656Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
657@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
658executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
659example that caused trouble initially:
660
661@smallexample
662(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
663Continuing.
664
665@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
666
667baz
6680000
669@end smallexample
670
671@noindent
672Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
673problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
674lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
675
676@smallexample
677@b{C-d}
678Program exited normally.
679@end smallexample
680
681@noindent
682The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
683indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
684session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
685
686@smallexample
687(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
688@end smallexample
c906108c 689
6d2ebf8b 690@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
691@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
692
693This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 694The essentials are:
c906108c 695@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 696@item
53a5351d 697type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 698@item
c906108c
SS
699type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
700@end itemize
701
702@menu
703* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
704* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
705* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
706@end menu
707
6d2ebf8b 708@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
709@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
710
c906108c
SS
711Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
712@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
713
714You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
715to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
716
c906108c
SS
717The command-line options described here are designed
718to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 719options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
720
721The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
722specifying an executable program:
723
724@example
725@value{GDBP} @var{program}
726@end example
727
c906108c
SS
728@noindent
729You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
730specified:
731
732@example
733@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
734@end example
735
736You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
737to debug a running process:
738
739@example
740@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
741@end example
742
743@noindent
744would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
745named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
746
c906108c 747Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
748complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
749debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
750``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
751will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 752
96a2c332 753You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
754@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
755
756@smallexample
757@value{GDBP} -silent
758@end smallexample
759
760@noindent
761You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
762options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
763
764@noindent
765Type
766
767@example
768@value{GDBP} -help
769@end example
770
771@noindent
772to display all available options and briefly describe their use
773(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
774
775All options and command line arguments you give are processed
776in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
777@samp{-x} option is used.
778
779
780@menu
c906108c
SS
781* File Options:: Choosing files
782* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
783@end menu
784
6d2ebf8b 785@node File Options
c906108c
SS
786@subsection Choosing files
787
2df3850c 788When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
789specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
790the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
791@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
792that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
793@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
794that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
795the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
796
797If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
798such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
799argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
800
801Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
802following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
803them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
804(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
805than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
806
d700128c
EZ
807@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
808@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
809@c it.
810
c906108c
SS
811@table @code
812@item -symbols @var{file}
813@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
814@cindex @code{--symbols}
815@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
816Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
817
818@item -exec @var{file}
819@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
820@cindex @code{--exec}
821@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
822Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
823and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
824
825@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 826@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
827Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
828file.
829
c906108c
SS
830@item -core @var{file}
831@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
832@cindex @code{--core}
833@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
834Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
835
836@item -c @var{number}
837Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
838(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
839case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
840
841@item -command @var{file}
842@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
843@cindex @code{--command}
844@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
845Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
846Files,, Command files}.
847
848@item -directory @var{directory}
849@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
850@cindex @code{--directory}
851@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
852Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
853
c906108c
SS
854@item -m
855@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
856@cindex @code{--mapped}
857@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
858@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
859supported on all systems.}@*
860If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 861system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
862to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
863program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 864called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
865Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
866and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
867the symbol table from the executable program.
868
869The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
870is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
871table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 872
c906108c
SS
873@item -r
874@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
875@cindex @code{--readnow}
876@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
877Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
878the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
879This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 880
c906108c
SS
881@end table
882
2df3850c 883You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 884order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
885information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
886on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
887but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
888
889@example
2df3850c 890gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 891@end example
c906108c 892
6d2ebf8b 893@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
894@subsection Choosing modes
895
896You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
897batch mode or quiet mode.
898
899@table @code
900@item -nx
901@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
902@cindex @code{--nx}
903@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
904Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
905called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
906@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
907options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
908files}.
c906108c
SS
909
910@item -quiet
d700128c 911@itemx -silent
c906108c 912@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
913@cindex @code{--quiet}
914@cindex @code{--silent}
915@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
916``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
917messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
918
919@item -batch
d700128c 920@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
921Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
922command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
923initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
924nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
925in the command files.
926
2df3850c
JM
927Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
928example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
929make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
930
931@example
932Program exited normally.
933@end example
934
935@noindent
2df3850c
JM
936(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
937@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
938mode.
939
940@item -nowindows
941@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
942@cindex @code{--nowindows}
943@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 944``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 945(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
946interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
947
948@item -windows
949@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
950@cindex @code{--windows}
951@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
952If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
953used if possible.
c906108c
SS
954
955@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 956@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
957Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
958instead of the current directory.
959
c906108c
SS
960@item -fullname
961@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
962@cindex @code{--fullname}
963@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
964@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
965subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
966number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
967displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
968recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
969the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
970and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
971@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
972frame.
c906108c 973
d700128c
EZ
974@item -epoch
975@cindex @code{--epoch}
976The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
977@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
978routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
979separate window.
980
981@item -annotate @var{level}
982@cindex @code{--annotate}
983This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
984effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
985(@pxref{Annotations}).
986Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
987together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
988types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
989@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
990maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
991
992@item -async
993@cindex @code{--async}
994Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
995@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
996special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
997commands in parallel with the debugged process being
998run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
999MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1000suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1001control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1002(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.0, the target side of the asynchronous
1003operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1004yet.)
1005@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1006@c should be removed.
1007
1008When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1009uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1010@samp{-noasync} option.
1011
1012@item -noasync
1013@cindex @code{--noasync}
1014Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1015
2df3850c
JM
1016@item -baud @var{bps}
1017@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1018@cindex @code{--baud}
1019@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1020Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1021interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1022
1023@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1024@itemx -t @var{device}
1025@cindex @code{--tty}
1026@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1027Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1028@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1029
53a5351d
JM
1030@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1031@c @item -tui
d700128c 1032@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
1033@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1034@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1035@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1036@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1037@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1038
1039@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1040@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1041@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1042@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1043@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1044@c systems.
1045
d700128c
EZ
1046@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1047@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1048Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1049program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1050communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
1051@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
7162c0ca 1052interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
d700128c
EZ
1053
1054@item -write
1055@cindex @code{--write}
1056Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1057is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1058(@pxref{Patching}).
1059
1060@item -statistics
1061@cindex @code{--statistics}
1062This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1063memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1064
1065@item -version
1066@cindex @code{--version}
1067This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1068no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1069
c906108c
SS
1070@end table
1071
6d2ebf8b 1072@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1073@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1074@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1075@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1076
1077@table @code
1078@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1079@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1080@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1081@itemx q
1082To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1083@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1084do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1085otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1086error code.
c906108c
SS
1087@end table
1088
1089@cindex interrupt
1090An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1091terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1092returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1093character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1094until a time when it is safe.
1095
c906108c
SS
1096If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1097device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1098(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1099
6d2ebf8b 1100@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1101@section Shell commands
1102
1103If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1104debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1105just use the @code{shell} command.
1106
1107@table @code
1108@kindex shell
1109@cindex shell escape
1110@item shell @var{command string}
1111Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1112If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1113shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1114(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1115@end table
1116
1117The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1118You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1119@value{GDBN}:
1120
1121@table @code
1122@kindex make
1123@cindex calling make
1124@item make @var{make-args}
1125Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1126arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1127@end table
1128
6d2ebf8b 1129@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1130@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1131
1132You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1133name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1134@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1135key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1136show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1137
1138@menu
1139* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1140* Completion:: Command completion
1141* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1142@end menu
1143
6d2ebf8b 1144@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1145@section Command syntax
1146
1147A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1148how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1149arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1150command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1151step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1152with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1153
1154@cindex abbreviation
1155@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1156unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1157documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1158abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1159equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1160names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1161arguments to the @code{help} command.
1162
1163@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1164@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1165A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1166repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1167will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1168repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1169repeat.
1170
1171The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1172@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1173exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1174
1175@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1176output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1177(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1178@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1179repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1180
41afff9a 1181@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1182@cindex comment
1183Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1184nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1185Files,,Command files}).
1186
6d2ebf8b 1187@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1188@section Command completion
1189
1190@cindex completion
1191@cindex word completion
1192@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1193only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1194are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1195commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1196
1197Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1198of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1199word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1200enter it). For example, if you type
1201
1202@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1203@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1204@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1205@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1206@example
1207(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1208@end example
1209
1210@noindent
1211@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1212the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1213
1214@example
1215(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1216@end example
1217
1218@noindent
1219You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1220breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1221@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1222were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1223might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1224to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1225
1226If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1227@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1228characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1229@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1230example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1231begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1232just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1233function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1234example:
1235
1236@example
1237(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1238@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1239make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1240make_abs_section make_function_type
1241make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1242make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1243make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1244(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1245@end example
1246
1247@noindent
1248After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1249partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1250command.
1251
1252If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1253can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1254means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1255key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1256one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1257
1258@cindex quotes in commands
1259@cindex completion of quoted strings
1260Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1261parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1262its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1263situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1264@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1265
c906108c
SS
1266The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1267name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1268(multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1269type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1270distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1271@code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1272@code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1273facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1274beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1275consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1276@kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1277
1278@example
96a2c332 1279(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1280bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1281(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1282@end example
1283
1284In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1285quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1286completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1287place:
1288
1289@example
1290(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1291@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1292(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1293@end example
1294
1295@noindent
1296In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1297you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1298completion on an overloaded symbol.
1299
d4f3574e 1300For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
c906108c
SS
1301expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1302overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
d4f3574e 1303see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
c906108c
SS
1304
1305
6d2ebf8b 1306@node Help
c906108c
SS
1307@section Getting help
1308@cindex online documentation
1309@kindex help
1310
5d161b24 1311You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1312using the command @code{help}.
1313
1314@table @code
41afff9a 1315@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1316@item help
1317@itemx h
1318You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1319display a short list of named classes of commands:
1320
1321@smallexample
1322(@value{GDBP}) help
1323List of classes of commands:
1324
2df3850c 1325aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1326breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1327data -- Examining data
c906108c 1328files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1329internals -- Maintenance commands
1330obscure -- Obscure features
1331running -- Running the program
1332stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1333status -- Status inquiries
1334support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1335tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1336 stopping the program
c906108c 1337user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1338
5d161b24 1339Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1340commands in that class.
5d161b24 1341Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1342documentation.
1343Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1344(@value{GDBP})
1345@end smallexample
96a2c332 1346@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1347
1348@item help @var{class}
1349Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1350list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1351help display for the class @code{status}:
1352
1353@smallexample
1354(@value{GDBP}) help status
1355Status inquiries.
1356
1357List of commands:
1358
1359@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1360@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1361info -- Generic command for showing things
1362 about the program being debugged
1363show -- Generic command for showing things
1364 about the debugger
c906108c 1365
5d161b24 1366Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1367documentation.
1368Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1369(@value{GDBP})
1370@end smallexample
1371
1372@item help @var{command}
1373With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1374short paragraph on how to use that command.
1375
6837a0a2
DB
1376@kindex apropos
1377@item apropos @var{args}
1378The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1379commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1380@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1381
1382@smallexample
1383apropos reload
1384@end smallexample
1385
1386@noindent results in:
1387
1388@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1389@c @group
1390set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1391 multiple times in one run
1392show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1393 multiple times in one run
1394@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1395@end smallexample
1396
c906108c
SS
1397@kindex complete
1398@item complete @var{args}
1399The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1400for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1401command you want completed. For example:
1402
1403@smallexample
1404complete i
1405@end smallexample
1406
1407@noindent results in:
1408
1409@smallexample
1410@group
2df3850c
JM
1411if
1412ignore
c906108c
SS
1413info
1414inspect
c906108c
SS
1415@end group
1416@end smallexample
1417
1418@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1419@end table
1420
1421In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1422and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1423of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1424manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1425under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1426all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1427
1428@c @group
1429@table @code
1430@kindex info
41afff9a 1431@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1432@item info
1433This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1434program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1435with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1436registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1437You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1438@w{@code{help info}}.
1439
1440@kindex set
1441@item set
5d161b24 1442You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1443@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1444@code{set prompt $}.
1445
1446@kindex show
1447@item show
5d161b24 1448In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1449@value{GDBN} itself.
1450You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1451related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1452system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1453which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1454
1455@kindex info set
1456To display all the settable parameters and their current
1457values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1458@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1459@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1460@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1461@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1462@end table
1463@c @end group
1464
1465Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1466exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1467
1468@table @code
1469@kindex show version
1470@cindex version number
1471@item show version
1472Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1473information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1474@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1475version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1476commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1477system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1478variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1479The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1480@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1481
1482@kindex show copying
1483@item show copying
1484Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1485
1486@kindex show warranty
1487@item show warranty
2df3850c 1488Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1489if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1490
c906108c
SS
1491@end table
1492
6d2ebf8b 1493@node Running
c906108c
SS
1494@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1495
1496When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1497debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1498
1499You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1500of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1501your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1502kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1503
1504@menu
1505* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1506* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1507* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1508* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1509
1510* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1511* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1512* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1513* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1514
1515* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1516* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1517@end menu
1518
6d2ebf8b 1519@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1520@section Compiling for debugging
1521
1522In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1523debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1524is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1525variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1526and addresses in the executable code.
1527
1528To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1529the compiler.
1530
1531Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1532options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1533executables containing debugging information.
1534
53a5351d
JM
1535@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1536without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1537recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1538program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1539in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1540
1541@cindex optimized code, debugging
1542@cindex debugging optimized code
1543When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1544optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1545really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1546exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1547variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1548variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1549
1550Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1551@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1552doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1553please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1554
1555Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1556@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1557format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1558
1559@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1560@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1561@section Starting your program
1562@cindex starting
1563@cindex running
1564
1565@table @code
1566@kindex run
41afff9a 1567@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1568@item run
1569@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1570Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1571You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1572argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1573@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1574(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1575
1576@end table
1577
c906108c
SS
1578If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1579supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1580that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1581@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1582
1583The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1584receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1585information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1586can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1587your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1588divided into four categories:
1589
1590@table @asis
1591@item The @emph{arguments.}
1592Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1593@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1594is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1595(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1596the arguments.
1597In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1598@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1599@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1600
1601@item The @emph{environment.}
1602Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1603use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1604environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1605your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1606
1607@item The @emph{working directory.}
1608Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1609the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1610@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1611
1612@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1613Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1614standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1615in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1616set a different device for your program.
1617@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1618
1619@cindex pipes
1620@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1621pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1622program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1623wrong program.
1624@end table
c906108c
SS
1625
1626When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1627immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1628of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1629stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1630or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1631
1632If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1633time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1634table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1635your current breakpoints.
1636
6d2ebf8b 1637@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1638@section Your program's arguments
1639
1640@cindex arguments (to your program)
1641The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1642@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1643They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1644performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1645@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1646@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1647the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1648
1649On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1650@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1651calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1652the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1653
1654@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1655@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1656
c906108c 1657@table @code
41afff9a 1658@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1659@item set args
1660Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1661@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1662with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1663using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1664it again without arguments.
1665
1666@kindex show args
1667@item show args
1668Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1669@end table
1670
6d2ebf8b 1671@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1672@section Your program's environment
1673
1674@cindex environment (of your program)
1675The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1676their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1677your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1678path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1679the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1680debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1681environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1682
1683@table @code
1684@kindex path
1685@item path @var{directory}
1686Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1687(the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
d4f3574e
SS
1688You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1689system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1690MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1691is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1692
1693You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1694working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1695use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1696@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1697@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1698@var{directory} to the search path.
1699@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1700@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1701
1702@kindex show paths
1703@item show paths
1704Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1705environment variable).
1706
1707@kindex show environment
1708@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1709Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1710your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1711print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1712your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1713
1714@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1715@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1716Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1717changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1718be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1719any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1720parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1721null value.
1722@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1723@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1724
1725For example, this command:
1726
1727@example
1728set env USER = foo
1729@end example
1730
1731@noindent
d4f3574e 1732tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1733@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1734are not actually required.)
1735
1736@kindex unset environment
1737@item unset environment @var{varname}
1738Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1739program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1740@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1741rather than assigning it an empty value.
1742@end table
1743
d4f3574e
SS
1744@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1745the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1746by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1747@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1748that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1749@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1750your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1751files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1752@file{.profile}.
1753
6d2ebf8b 1754@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1755@section Your program's working directory
1756
1757@cindex working directory (of your program)
1758Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1759working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1760The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1761from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1762working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1763
1764The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1765that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1766specify files}.
1767
1768@table @code
1769@kindex cd
1770@item cd @var{directory}
1771Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1772
1773@kindex pwd
1774@item pwd
1775Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1776@end table
1777
6d2ebf8b 1778@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1779@section Your program's input and output
1780
1781@cindex redirection
1782@cindex i/o
1783@cindex terminal
1784By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1785the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1786to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1787modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1788running your program.
1789
1790@table @code
1791@kindex info terminal
1792@item info terminal
1793Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1794program is using.
1795@end table
1796
1797You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1798redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1799
1800@example
1801run > outfile
1802@end example
1803
1804@noindent
1805starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1806
1807@kindex tty
1808@cindex controlling terminal
1809Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1810with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1811argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1812commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1813process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1814
1815@example
1816tty /dev/ttyb
1817@end example
1818
1819@noindent
1820directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1821default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1822that as their controlling terminal.
1823
1824An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1825effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1826terminal.
1827
1828When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1829command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1830for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1831
6d2ebf8b 1832@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1833@section Debugging an already-running process
1834@kindex attach
1835@cindex attach
1836
1837@table @code
1838@item attach @var{process-id}
1839This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1840outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1841targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1842find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1843or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1844
1845@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1846executing the command.
1847@end table
1848
1849To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1850which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1851programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1852also have permission to send the process a signal.
1853
1854When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1855the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1856the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1857(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1858the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1859Specify Files}.
1860
1861The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1862process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1863with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1864you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1865can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1866process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1867attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1868
1869@table @code
1870@kindex detach
1871@item detach
1872When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1873@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1874the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1875that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1876are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1877@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1878executing the command.
1879@end table
1880
1881If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1882attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1883for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1884control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1885confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1886messages}).
1887
6d2ebf8b 1888@node Kill Process
c906108c 1889@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1890
1891@table @code
1892@kindex kill
1893@item kill
1894Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1895@end table
1896
1897This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1898running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1899is running.
1900
1901On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1902while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1903@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1904outside the debugger.
1905
1906The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1907relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1908executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1909next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1910reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1911breakpoint settings).
1912
6d2ebf8b 1913@node Threads
c906108c 1914@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1915
1916@cindex threads of execution
1917@cindex multiple threads
1918@cindex switching threads
1919In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1920may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1921of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1922the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1923that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1924modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1925registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1926
1927@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1928programs:
1929
1930@itemize @bullet
1931@item automatic notification of new threads
1932@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1933@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1934@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1935a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1936@item thread-specific breakpoints
1937@end itemize
1938
c906108c
SS
1939@quotation
1940@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1941@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1942If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1943effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1944from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1945like this:
1946
1947@smallexample
1948(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1949(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1950Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1951see the IDs of currently known threads.
1952@end smallexample
1953@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1954@c doesn't support threads"?
1955@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1956
1957@cindex focus of debugging
1958@cindex current thread
1959The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1960threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1961control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1962This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1963program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1964
41afff9a 1965@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1966@cindex thread identifier (system)
1967@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1968@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1969@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1970Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1971the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1972form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1973whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1974LynxOS, you might see
1975
1976@example
1977[New process 35 thread 27]
1978@end example
1979
1980@noindent
1981when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1982the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1983further qualifier.
1984
1985@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1986@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1987@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1988@c program?
1989@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1990@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 1991@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
1992
1993@cindex thread number
1994@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1995For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1996number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1997
1998@table @code
1999@kindex info threads
2000@item info threads
2001Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2002program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2003
2004@enumerate
2005@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2006
2007@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2008
2009@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2010@end enumerate
2011
2012@noindent
2013An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2014indicates the current thread.
2015
5d161b24 2016For example,
c906108c
SS
2017@end table
2018@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2019
2020@smallexample
2021(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2022 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2023 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2024* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2025 at threadtest.c:68
2026@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2027
2028On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2029
2030@cindex thread number
2031@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2032For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2033number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2034thread in your program.
2035
41afff9a
EZ
2036@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2037@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2038@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2039@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2040@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2041Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2042both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2043form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2044whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2045HP-UX, you see
2046
2047@example
2048[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2049@end example
2050
2051@noindent
5d161b24 2052when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2053
2054@table @code
2055@kindex info threads
2056@item info threads
2057Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2058program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2059
2060@enumerate
2061@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2062
2063@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2064
2065@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2066@end enumerate
2067
2068@noindent
2069An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2070indicates the current thread.
2071
5d161b24 2072For example,
c906108c
SS
2073@end table
2074@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2075
2076@example
2077(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2078 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2079 at quicksort.c:137
2080 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2081 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2082 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2083 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2084@end example
c906108c
SS
2085
2086@table @code
2087@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2088@item thread @var{threadno}
2089Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2090argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2091shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2092@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2093you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2094
2095@smallexample
2096@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2097(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2098[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
20990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2100@end smallexample
2101
2102@noindent
2103As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2104@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2105threads.
c906108c
SS
2106
2107@kindex thread apply
2108@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2109The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2110more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2111with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2112@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2113threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2114@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2115@end table
2116
2117@cindex automatic thread selection
2118@cindex switching threads automatically
2119@cindex threads, automatic switching
2120Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2121signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2122signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2123message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2124thread.
2125
2126@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2127more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2128programs with multiple threads.
2129
2130@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2131watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2132
6d2ebf8b 2133@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2134@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2135
2136@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2137@cindex multiple processes
2138@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2139On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2140programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2141function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2142parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2143set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2144will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2145will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2146
2147However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2148which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2149the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2150only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2151so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2152on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2153get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2154@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2155the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2156the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2157
53a5351d
JM
2158On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2159debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2160@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2161
2162By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2163the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2164
2165If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2166use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2167
2168@table @code
2169@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2170@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2171Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2172@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2173process. The @var{mode} can be:
2174
2175@table @code
2176@item parent
2177The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2178unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2179
2180@item child
2181The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2182unimpeded.
2183
2184@item ask
2185The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2186@end table
2187
2188@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2189Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2190@end table
2191
2192If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2193@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2194breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2195@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2196the child process's @code{main}.
2197
2198When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2199child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2200
2201If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2202call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2203use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2204argument.
2205
2206You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2207a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2208Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2209
6d2ebf8b 2210@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2211@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2212
2213The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2214program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2215trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2216
7a292a7a
SS
2217Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2218such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2219@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2220change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2221continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2222ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2223explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2224
2225@table @code
2226@kindex info program
2227@item info program
2228Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2229running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2230@end table
2231
2232@menu
2233* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2234* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2235* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2236* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2237@end menu
2238
6d2ebf8b 2239@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2240@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2241
2242@cindex breakpoints
2243A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2244the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2245control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2246breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2247Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2248should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2249program.
2250
2251In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2252breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2253a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2254is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2255not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2256arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2257
2258@cindex watchpoints
2259@cindex memory tracing
2260@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2261@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2262A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2263when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2264command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2265watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2266any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2267and watchpoints using the same commands.
2268
2269You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2270whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2271Automatic display}.
2272
2273@cindex catchpoints
2274@cindex breakpoint on events
2275A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2276when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2277exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2278different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2279catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2280other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2281@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2282
2283@cindex breakpoint numbers
2284@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2285@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2286catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2287starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2288features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2289breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2290@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2291enable it again.
2292
c5394b80
JM
2293@cindex breakpoint ranges
2294@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2295Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2296operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2297@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2298hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2299all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2300
c906108c
SS
2301@menu
2302* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2303* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2304* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2305* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2306* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2307* Conditions:: Break conditions
2308* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2309* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2310* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2311@end menu
2312
6d2ebf8b 2313@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2314@subsection Setting breakpoints
2315
5d161b24 2316@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2317@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2318@c
2319@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2320
2321@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2322@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2323@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2324@cindex latest breakpoint
2325Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2326@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2327number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2328Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2329convenience variables.
2330
2331You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2332
2333@table @code
2334@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2335Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c
SS
2336When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2337C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2338@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2339
2340@item break +@var{offset}
2341@itemx break -@var{offset}
2342Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2343at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2344(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2345
2346@item break @var{linenum}
2347Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2348The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2349The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2350code on that line.
2351
2352@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2353Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2354
2355@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2356Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2357@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2358superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2359functions.
2360
2361@item break *@var{address}
2362Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2363breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2364information or source files.
2365
2366@item break
2367When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2368the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2369(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2370innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2371returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2372@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2373that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2374@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2375the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2376inside loops.
2377
2378@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2379least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2380would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2381breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2382existed when your program stopped.
2383
2384@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2385Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2386@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2387value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2388@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2389above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2390,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2391
2392@kindex tbreak
2393@item tbreak @var{args}
2394Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2395same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2396way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2397program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2398
c906108c
SS
2399@kindex hbreak
2400@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2401Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2402@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2403breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2404have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2405debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2406changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2407provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2408will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2409address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2410breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2411example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2412@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2413or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2414(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2415
2416@kindex thbreak
2417@item thbreak @var{args}
2418Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2419are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2420the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2421the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2422first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2423command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2424may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2425See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2426
2427@kindex rbreak
2428@cindex regular expression
2429@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2430Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2431@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2432matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2433breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2434the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2435them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2436
2437The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2438like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2439shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2440an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2441@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2442match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2443
c906108c
SS
2444When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2445breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2446classes.
c906108c
SS
2447
2448@kindex info breakpoints
2449@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2450@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2451@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2452@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2453Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2454not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2455
2456@table @emph
2457@item Breakpoint Numbers
2458@item Type
2459Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2460@item Disposition
2461Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2462@item Enabled or Disabled
2463Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2464that are not enabled.
2465@item Address
2df3850c 2466Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2467@item What
2468Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2469line number.
2470@end table
2471
2472@noindent
2473If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2474the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2475are listed after that.
2476
2477@noindent
2478@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2479number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2480convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2481the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2482listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2483
2484@noindent
2485@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2486has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2487@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2488hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2489was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2490will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2491@end table
2492
2493@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2494your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2495the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2496(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2497
2498@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2499@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2500@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2501purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2502These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2503@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2504
2505You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2506@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2507
2508@table @code
2509@kindex maint info breakpoints
2510@item maint info breakpoints
2511Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2512breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2513internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2514breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2515is shown:
2516
2517@table @code
2518@item breakpoint
2519Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2520
2521@item watchpoint
2522Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2523
2524@item longjmp
2525Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2526@code{longjmp} calls.
2527
2528@item longjmp resume
2529Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2530
2531@item until
2532Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2533
2534@item finish
2535Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2536
c906108c
SS
2537@item shlib events
2538Shared library events.
53a5351d 2539
c906108c 2540@end table
53a5351d 2541
c906108c
SS
2542@end table
2543
2544
6d2ebf8b 2545@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2546@subsection Setting watchpoints
2547
2548@cindex setting watchpoints
2549@cindex software watchpoints
2550@cindex hardware watchpoints
2551You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2552expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2553this may happen.
2554
2555Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2556hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2557program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2558times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2559catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2560culprit.)
2561
d4f3574e 2562On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2563@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2564hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2565program.
2566
2567@table @code
2568@kindex watch
2569@item watch @var{expr}
2570Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2571is written into by the program and its value changes.
2572
2573@kindex rwatch
2574@item rwatch @var{expr}
2575Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2576
2577@kindex awatch
2578@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2579Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2580by the program.
c906108c
SS
2581
2582@kindex info watchpoints
2583@item info watchpoints
2584This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2585it is the same as @code{info break}.
2586@end table
2587
2588@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2589watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2590value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2591cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2592executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2593statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2594
2595When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2596
2597@example
2598Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2599@end example
2600
2601@noindent
2602if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2603
7be570e7
JM
2604Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2605hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2606value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2607every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2608that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2609hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2610will print a message like this:
2611
2612@smallexample
2613Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2614@end smallexample
2615
2616Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2617data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2618watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2619can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2620cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2621double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2622wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2623into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2624
2625If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2626to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2627Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2628time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2629able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2630warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2631
2632@smallexample
2633Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2634@end smallexample
2635
2636@noindent
2637If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2638
2639The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2640or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2641data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2642hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2643both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2644watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2645@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2646watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2647@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2648Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2649
2650If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2651any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2652kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2653
7be570e7
JM
2654@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2655(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2656they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2657which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2658being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2659and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2660rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2661way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2662@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2663
c906108c
SS
2664@quotation
2665@cindex watchpoints and threads
2666@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2667@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2668usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2669can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2670you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2671thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2672can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2673@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2674the expression.
53a5351d 2675
d4f3574e 2676@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2677@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2678have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2679watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2680single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2681change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2682confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2683software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2684when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2685watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2686@end quotation
c906108c 2687
6d2ebf8b 2688@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2689@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2690@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2691@cindex exception handlers
2692@cindex event handling
2693
2694You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2695kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2696shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2697
2698@table @code
2699@kindex catch
2700@item catch @var{event}
2701Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2702@table @code
2703@item throw
2704@kindex catch throw
2705The throwing of a C++ exception.
2706
2707@item catch
2708@kindex catch catch
2709The catching of a C++ exception.
2710
2711@item exec
2712@kindex catch exec
2713A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2714
2715@item fork
2716@kindex catch fork
2717A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2718
2719@item vfork
2720@kindex catch vfork
2721A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2722
2723@item load
2724@itemx load @var{libname}
2725@kindex catch load
2726The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2727@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2728
2729@item unload
2730@itemx unload @var{libname}
2731@kindex catch unload
2732The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2733of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2734@end table
2735
2736@item tcatch @var{event}
2737Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2738automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2739
2740@end table
2741
2742Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2743
2744There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2745(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2746
2747@itemize @bullet
2748@item
2749If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2750control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2751raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2752returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2753simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2754that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2755you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2756disabled within interactive calls.
2757
2758@item
2759You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2760
2761@item
2762You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2763@end itemize
2764
2765@cindex raise exceptions
2766Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2767if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2768stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2769can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2770breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2771out where the exception was raised.
2772
2773To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2774knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2775raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2776which has the following ANSI C interface:
2777
2778@example
2779 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2780 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2781 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2782@end example
2783
2784@noindent
2785To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2786unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2787(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2788
2789With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2790that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2791a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2792breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2793raised.
2794
2795
6d2ebf8b 2796@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2797@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2798
2799@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2800@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2801It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2802catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2803to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2804breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2805
2806With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2807where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2808delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2809their breakpoint numbers.
2810
2811It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2812automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2813when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2814
2815@table @code
2816@kindex clear
2817@item clear
2818Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2819selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2820the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2821breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2822
2823@item clear @var{function}
2824@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2825Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2826
2827@item clear @var{linenum}
2828@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2829Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2830
2831@cindex delete breakpoints
2832@kindex delete
41afff9a 2833@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2834@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2835Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2836ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2837breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2838confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2839@end table
2840
6d2ebf8b 2841@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2842@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2843
2844@kindex disable breakpoints
2845@kindex enable breakpoints
2846Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2847prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2848it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2849that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2850
2851You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2852the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2853or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2854@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2855catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2856
2857A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2858states of enablement:
2859
2860@itemize @bullet
2861@item
2862Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2863with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2864@item
2865Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2866@item
2867Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2868disabled.
c906108c
SS
2869@item
2870Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2871immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2872set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2873@end itemize
2874
2875You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2876watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex disable breakpoints
2880@kindex disable
41afff9a 2881@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2882@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2883Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2884listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2885options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2886case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2887@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2888
2889@kindex enable breakpoints
2890@kindex enable
c5394b80 2891@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2892Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2893become effective once again in stopping your program.
2894
c5394b80 2895@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2896Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2897of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2898
c5394b80 2899@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2900Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2901deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2902@end table
2903
d4f3574e
SS
2904@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2905@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2906Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2907,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2908subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2909the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2910breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2911breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2912stepping}.)
2913
6d2ebf8b 2914@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2915@subsection Break conditions
2916@cindex conditional breakpoints
2917@cindex breakpoint conditions
2918
2919@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2920@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2921The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2922specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2923breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2924programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2925a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2926and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2927
2928This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2929situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2930when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2931by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2932@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2933
2934Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2935since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2936it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2937and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2938one.
2939
2940Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2941your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2942that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2943format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2944unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2945that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2946program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2947breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2948conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2949purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2950(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2951
2952Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2953@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2954Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2955with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2956
c906108c
SS
2957You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2958The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2959@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2960catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2961
2962@table @code
2963@kindex condition
2964@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2965Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2966watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2967breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2968@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2969@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2970syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2971referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2972symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2973prints an error message:
2974
2975@example
2976No symbol "foo" in current context.
2977@end example
2978
2979@noindent
c906108c
SS
2980@value{GDBN} does
2981not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2982command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2983@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2984
2985@item condition @var{bnum}
2986Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2987an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2988@end table
2989
2990@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2991A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2992breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2993useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2994count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2995is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2996therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2997ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2998the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2999value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3000your program reaches it.
3001
3002@table @code
3003@kindex ignore
3004@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3005Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3006The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3007execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3008takes no action.
3009
3010To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3011a count of zero.
3012
3013When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3014breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3015@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3016Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3017
3018If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3019condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3020@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3021
3022You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3023as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3024is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3025variables}.
3026@end table
3027
3028Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3029
3030
6d2ebf8b 3031@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3032@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3033
3034@cindex breakpoint commands
3035You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3036commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3037example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3038enable other breakpoints.
3039
3040@table @code
3041@kindex commands
3042@kindex end
3043@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3044@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3045@itemx end
3046Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3047themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3048@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3049
3050To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3051follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3052
3053With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3054breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3055recently encountered).
3056@end table
3057
3058Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3059disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3060
3061You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3062use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3063that resumes execution.
3064
3065Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3066execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3067(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3068another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3069ambiguities about which list to execute.
3070
3071@kindex silent
3072If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3073usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3074be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3075then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3076see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3077meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3078
3079The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3080print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3081breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3082
3083For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3084value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3085
3086@example
3087break foo if x>0
3088commands
3089silent
3090printf "x is %d\n",x
3091cont
3092end
3093@end example
3094
3095One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3096you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3097of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3098erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3099to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3100so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3101command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3102
3103@example
3104break 403
3105commands
3106silent
3107set x = y + 4
3108cont
3109end
3110@end example
3111
6d2ebf8b 3112@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3113@subsection Breakpoint menus
3114@cindex overloading
3115@cindex symbol overloading
3116
3117Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
3118to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3119This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3120@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3121a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3122something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3123particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3124you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3125waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3126options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3127sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3128@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3129breakpoints.
3130
3131For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3132breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3133We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3134
3135@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3136@smallexample
3137@group
3138(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3139[0] cancel
3140[1] all
3141[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3142[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3143[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3144[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3145[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3146[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3147> 2 4 6
3148Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3149Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3150Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3151Multiple breakpoints were set.
3152Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3153 breakpoints.
3154(@value{GDBP})
3155@end group
3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3159@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3160@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3161@c
3162@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3163@c
d4f3574e
SS
3164Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3165any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3166attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3167@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3168
3169@example
3170Cannot insert breakpoints.
3171The same program may be running in another process.
3172@end example
3173
3174When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3175
3176@enumerate
3177@item
3178Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3179
3180@item
5d161b24 3181Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3182name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3183that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3184Then start your program again.
3185
3186@item
3187Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3188linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3189to nonsharable executables.
3190@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3191@c @end ifclear
3192
d4f3574e
SS
3193A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3194hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3195
3196@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3197@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3198@smallexample
3199Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3200You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3201@end smallexample
3202
3203@noindent
3204This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3205only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3206watchpoints it needs to insert.
3207
3208When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3209hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3210
3211
6d2ebf8b 3212@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3213@section Continuing and stepping
3214
3215@cindex stepping
3216@cindex continuing
3217@cindex resuming execution
3218@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3219completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3220one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3221line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3222particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3223your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3224it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3225@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3226
3227@table @code
3228@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3229@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3230@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3231@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3232@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3233@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3234Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3235any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3236@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3237ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3238@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3239
3240The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3241stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3242@code{continue} is ignored.
3243
d4f3574e
SS
3244The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3245debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3246purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3247@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3248@end table
3249
3250To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3251(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3252calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3253different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3254
3255A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3256(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3257beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3258is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3259and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3260interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3261
3262@table @code
3263@kindex step
41afff9a 3264@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3265@item step
3266Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3267line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3268abbreviated @code{s}.
3269
3270@quotation
3271@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3272@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3273@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3274@c distinction here.
3275@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3276within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3277execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3278debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3279is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3280without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3281below.
3282@end quotation
3283
4a92d011
EZ
3284The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3285line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3286@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3287to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3288the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3289called within the line.
c906108c 3290
d4f3574e
SS
3291Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3292number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3293@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3294on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3295was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3296
3297@item step @var{count}
3298Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3299breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3300@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3301
3302@kindex next
41afff9a 3303@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3304@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3305Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3306This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3307the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3308control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3309that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3310is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3311
3312An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3313
3314
3315@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3316@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3317@c
3318@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3319@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3320@c function are executed without stopping.
3321
d4f3574e
SS
3322The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3323source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3324@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3325
b90a5f51
CF
3326@kindex set step-mode
3327@item set step-mode
3328@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3329@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3330@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3331The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3332stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3333information rather than stepping over it.
3334
4a92d011
EZ
3335This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3336machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3337want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3338
3339@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3340Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3341debug information. This is the default.
3342
c906108c
SS
3343@kindex finish
3344@item finish
3345Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3346returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3347
3348Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3349,Returning from a function}).
3350
3351@kindex until
41afff9a 3352@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3353@item until
3354@itemx u
3355Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3356current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3357stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3358command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3359automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3360than the address of the jump.
3361
3362This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3363though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3364exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3365simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3366through the next iteration.
3367
3368@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3369stack frame.
3370
3371@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3372of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3373example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3374(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3375@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3376
3377@example
3378(@value{GDBP}) f
3379#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3380206 expand_input();
3381(@value{GDBP}) until
3382195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3383@end example
3384
3385This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3386generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3387start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3388written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3389to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3390expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3391statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3392
3393@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3394instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3395argument.
3396
3397@item until @var{location}
3398@itemx u @var{location}
3399Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3400reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3401the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3402,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3403and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3404
3405@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3406@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3407@item stepi
96a2c332 3408@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3409@itemx si
3410Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3411
3412It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3413instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3414instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3415Display,, Automatic display}.
3416
3417An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3418
3419@need 750
3420@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3421@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3422@item nexti
96a2c332 3423@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3424@itemx ni
3425Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3426proceed until the function returns.
3427
3428An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3429@end table
3430
6d2ebf8b 3431@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3432@section Signals
3433@cindex signals
3434
3435A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3436operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3437kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3438signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3439@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3440memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3441the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3442requested an alarm).
3443
3444@cindex fatal signals
3445Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3446functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3447errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3448program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3449@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3450fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3451
3452@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3453program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3454signal.
3455
3456@cindex handling signals
3457Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3458(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3459but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3460You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3461
3462@table @code
3463@kindex info signals
3464@item info signals
96a2c332 3465@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3466Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3467handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3468the defined types of signals.
3469
d4f3574e 3470@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3471
3472@kindex handle
3473@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5d161b24 3474Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
c906108c
SS
3475be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3476beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3477@end table
3478
3479@c @group
3480The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3481Their full names are:
3482
3483@table @code
3484@item nostop
3485@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3486still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3487
3488@item stop
3489@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3490the @code{print} keyword as well.
3491
3492@item print
3493@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3494
3495@item noprint
3496@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3497implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3498
3499@item pass
3500@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3501can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3502and not handled.
3503
3504@item nopass
3505@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3506@end table
3507@c @end group
3508
d4f3574e
SS
3509When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3510program until you
c906108c
SS
3511continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3512effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3513after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3514command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3515program sees that signal when you continue.
3516
3517You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3518seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3519or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3520due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3521values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3522execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3523a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3524you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3525program a signal}.
c906108c 3526
6d2ebf8b 3527@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3528@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3529
3530When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3531programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3532breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3533
3534@table @code
3535@cindex breakpoints and threads
3536@cindex thread breakpoints
3537@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3538@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3539@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3540@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3541writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3542
3543Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3544to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3545particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3546numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3547column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3548
3549If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3550breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3551program.
3552
3553You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3554well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3555breakpoint condition, like this:
3556
3557@smallexample
2df3850c 3558(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3559@end smallexample
3560
3561@end table
3562
3563@cindex stopped threads
3564@cindex threads, stopped
3565Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3566@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3567allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3568switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3569underfoot.
3570
3571@cindex continuing threads
3572@cindex threads, continuing
3573Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3574executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3575like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3576
3577In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3578Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3579system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3580execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3581single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3582statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3583stops.
3584
3585You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3586continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3587thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3588first thread completes whatever you requested.
3589
3590On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3591thread to run.
3592
3593@table @code
3594@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3595Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3596locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3597current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3598mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3599``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3600stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3601when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3602function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3603like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3604thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3605@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3606
3607@item show scheduler-locking
3608Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3609@end table
3610
c906108c 3611
6d2ebf8b 3612@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3613@chapter Examining the Stack
3614
3615When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3616stopped and how it got there.
3617
3618@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3619Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3620is generated.
3621That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3622the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3623and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3624The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3625The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3626stack}.
3627
3628When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3629stack allow you to see all of this information.
3630
3631@cindex selected frame
3632One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3633@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3634particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3635your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3636special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3637interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3638
3639When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3640currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3641@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3642
3643@menu
3644* Frames:: Stack frames
3645* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3646* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3647* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3648
3649@end menu
3650
6d2ebf8b 3651@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3652@section Stack frames
3653
d4f3574e 3654@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3655@cindex stack frame
3656The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3657frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3658with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3659to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3660which the function is executing.
3661
3662@cindex initial frame
3663@cindex outermost frame
3664@cindex innermost frame
3665When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3666function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3667@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3668made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3669is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3670the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3671actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3672recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3673
3674@cindex frame pointer
3675Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3676stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3677kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3678address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3679in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3680going on in that frame.
3681
3682@cindex frame number
3683@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3684zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3685and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3686they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3687frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3688
6d2ebf8b
SS
3689@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3690@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3691@cindex frameless execution
3692Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3693without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3694@example
3695@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3696@end example
3697generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3698This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3699the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3700with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3701has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3702it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3703correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3704no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3705
3706@table @code
d4f3574e 3707@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3708@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3709@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3710The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3711and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3712address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3713@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3714
3715@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3716@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3717@item select-frame
3718The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3719to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3720@code{frame}.
3721@end table
3722
6d2ebf8b 3723@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3724@section Backtraces
3725
3726@cindex backtraces
3727@cindex tracebacks
3728@cindex stack traces
3729A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3730line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3731frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3732stack.
3733
3734@table @code
3735@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3736@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3737@item backtrace
3738@itemx bt
3739Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3740frames in the stack.
3741
3742You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3743character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3744
3745@item backtrace @var{n}
3746@itemx bt @var{n}
3747Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3748
3749@item backtrace -@var{n}
3750@itemx bt -@var{n}
3751Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3752@end table
3753
3754@kindex where
3755@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3756@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3757The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3758are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3759
3760Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3761The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3762print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3763line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3764counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3765line number.
3766
3767Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3768@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3769
3770@smallexample
3771@group
5d161b24 3772#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3773 at builtin.c:993
3774#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3775#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3776 at macro.c:71
3777(More stack frames follow...)
3778@end group
3779@end smallexample
3780
3781@noindent
3782The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3783value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3784code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3785
6d2ebf8b 3786@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3787@section Selecting a frame
3788
3789Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3790whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3791selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3792of the stack frame just selected.
3793
3794@table @code
d4f3574e 3795@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3796@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3797@item frame @var{n}
3798@itemx f @var{n}
3799Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3800(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3801innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3802@code{main}.
3803
3804@item frame @var{addr}
3805@itemx f @var{addr}
3806Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3807chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3808impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3809addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3810switches between them.
3811
c906108c
SS
3812On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3813select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3814
3815On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3816pointer and a program counter.
3817
3818On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3819pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3820@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3821@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3822@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3823
3824@kindex up
3825@item up @var{n}
3826Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3827advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3828that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3829
3830@kindex down
41afff9a 3831@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3832@item down @var{n}
3833Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3834advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3835that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3836abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3837@end table
3838
3839All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3840frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3841arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3842frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3843
3844@need 1000
3845For example:
3846
3847@smallexample
3848@group
3849(@value{GDBP}) up
3850#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3851 at env.c:10
385210 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3853@end group
3854@end smallexample
3855
3856After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3857prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3858@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3859
3860@table @code
3861@kindex down-silently
3862@kindex up-silently
3863@item up-silently @var{n}
3864@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3865These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3866respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3867causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3868in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3869distracting.
3870@end table
3871
6d2ebf8b 3872@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3873@section Information about a frame
3874
3875There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3876stack frame.
3877
3878@table @code
3879@item frame
3880@itemx f
3881When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3882frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3883selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3884argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3885@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3886
3887@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3888@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3889@item info frame
3890@itemx info f
3891This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3892including:
3893
3894@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3895@item
3896the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3897@item
3898the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3899@item
3900the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3901@item
3902the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3903@item
3904the address of the frame's arguments
3905@item
d4f3574e
SS
3906the address of the frame's local variables
3907@item
c906108c
SS
3908the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3909@item
3910which registers were saved in the frame
3911@end itemize
3912
3913@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3914something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3915the usual conventions.
3916
3917@item info frame @var{addr}
3918@itemx info f @var{addr}
3919Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3920selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3921command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3922architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3923@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3924
3925@kindex info args
3926@item info args
3927Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3928
3929@item info locals
3930@kindex info locals
3931Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3932line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3933accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3934
c906108c 3935@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3936@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3937@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3938@item info catch
3939Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3940current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3941exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3942@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3943@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3944
c906108c
SS
3945@end table
3946
c906108c 3947
6d2ebf8b 3948@node Source
c906108c
SS
3949@chapter Examining Source Files
3950
3951@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3952information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3953used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3954the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3955(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3956execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3957source files by explicit command.
3958
7a292a7a 3959If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3960prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3961@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3962
3963@menu
3964* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3965* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3966* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3967* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3968@end menu
3969
6d2ebf8b 3970@node List
c906108c
SS
3971@section Printing source lines
3972
3973@kindex list
41afff9a 3974@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 3975To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 3976(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
3977There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3978
3979Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3980
3981@table @code
3982@item list @var{linenum}
3983Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3984current source file.
3985
3986@item list @var{function}
3987Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3988@var{function}.
3989
3990@item list
3991Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3992@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3993printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3994as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3995Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3996
3997@item list -
3998Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3999@end table
4000
4001By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4002the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4003
4004@table @code
4005@kindex set listsize
4006@item set listsize @var{count}
4007Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4008the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4009
4010@kindex show listsize
4011@item show listsize
4012Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4013@end table
4014
4015Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4016so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4017than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4018argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4019each repetition moves up in the source file.
4020
4021@cindex linespec
4022In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4023@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4024of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4025Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4026
4027@table @code
4028@item list @var{linespec}
4029Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4030
4031@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4032Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4033linespecs.
4034
4035@item list ,@var{last}
4036Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4037
4038@item list @var{first},
4039Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4040
4041@item list +
4042Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4043
4044@item list -
4045Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4046
4047@item list
4048As described in the preceding table.
4049@end table
4050
4051Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4052kinds of linespec.
4053
4054@table @code
4055@item @var{number}
4056Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4057When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4058the same source file as the first linespec.
4059
4060@item +@var{offset}
4061Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4062When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4063two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4064first linespec.
4065
4066@item -@var{offset}
4067Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4068
4069@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4070Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4071
4072@item @var{function}
4073Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4074For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4075
4076@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4077Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4078function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4079file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4080identically named functions in different source files.
4081
4082@item *@var{address}
4083Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4084@var{address} may be any expression.
4085@end table
4086
6d2ebf8b 4087@node Search
c906108c
SS
4088@section Searching source files
4089@cindex searching
4090@kindex reverse-search
4091
4092There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4093regular expression.
4094
4095@table @code
4096@kindex search
4097@kindex forward-search
4098@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4099@itemx search @var{regexp}
4100The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4101starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4102@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4103synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4104@code{fo}.
4105
4106@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4107The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4108with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4109for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4110this command as @code{rev}.
4111@end table
c906108c 4112
6d2ebf8b 4113@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4114@section Specifying source directories
4115
4116@cindex source path
4117@cindex directories for source files
4118Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4119files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4120the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4121session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4122this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4123it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4124in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4125the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4126the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4127path.
4128
4129If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4130object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4131too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4132compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4133last resort.
4134
4135Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4136any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4137each line is in the file.
4138
4139@kindex directory
4140@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4141When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4142and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4143To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4144
4145@table @code
4146@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4147@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4148Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4149directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4150(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4151part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4152whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4153path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4154
4155@kindex cdir
4156@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4157@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4158@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4159@cindex compilation directory
4160@cindex current directory
4161@cindex working directory
4162@cindex directory, current
4163@cindex directory, compilation
4164You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4165directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4166working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4167tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4168session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4169directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4170
4171@item directory
4172Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4173
4174@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4175@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4176
4177@item show directories
4178@kindex show directories
4179Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4180@end table
4181
4182If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4183interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4184versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4185
4186@enumerate
4187@item
4188Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4189
4190@item
4191Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4192directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4193directories in one command.
4194@end enumerate
4195
6d2ebf8b 4196@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4197@section Source and machine code
4198
4199You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4200addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4201a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4202mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4203line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4204well as hex.
4205
4206@table @code
4207@kindex info line
4208@item info line @var{linespec}
4209Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4210source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4211the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4212source lines}).
4213@end table
4214
4215For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4216the object code for the first line of function
4217@code{m4_changequote}:
4218
d4f3574e
SS
4219@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4220@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4221@smallexample
96a2c332 4222(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4223Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4224@end smallexample
4225
4226@noindent
4227We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4228@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4229@smallexample
4230(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4231Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4232@end smallexample
4233
4234@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4235@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4236After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4237is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4238sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4239,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4240convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4241variables}).
4242
4243@table @code
4244@kindex disassemble
4245@cindex assembly instructions
4246@cindex instructions, assembly
4247@cindex machine instructions
4248@cindex listing machine instructions
4249@item disassemble
4250This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4251instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4252program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4253command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4254surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4255(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4256@end table
4257
c906108c
SS
4258The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4259HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4260
4261@smallexample
4262(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4263Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42640x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42650x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
42660x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
42670x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
42680x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
42690x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
42700x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
42710x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4272End of assembler dump.
4273@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4274
4275Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4276mnemonics or other syntax.
4277
4278@table @code
d4f3574e 4279@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4280@cindex assembly instructions
4281@cindex instructions, assembly
4282@cindex machine instructions
4283@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4284@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4285@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4286@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4287Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4288program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4289
4290Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4291can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4292The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4293assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4294@end table
4295
4296
6d2ebf8b 4297@node Data
c906108c
SS
4298@chapter Examining Data
4299
4300@cindex printing data
4301@cindex examining data
4302@kindex print
4303@kindex inspect
4304@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4305@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4306@c different window or something like that.
4307The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4308command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4309evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4310program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4311Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4312
4313@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4314@item print @var{expr}
4315@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4316@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4317value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4318you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4319@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4320formats}.
4321
4322@item print
4323@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4324If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4325@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4326conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4327@end table
4328
4329A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4330It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4331specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4332
7a292a7a 4333If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4334fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4335command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4336Table}.
c906108c
SS
4337
4338@menu
4339* Expressions:: Expressions
4340* Variables:: Program variables
4341* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4342* Output Formats:: Output formats
4343* Memory:: Examining memory
4344* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4345* Print Settings:: Print settings
4346* Value History:: Value history
4347* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4348* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4349* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4350* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4351@end menu
4352
6d2ebf8b 4353@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4354@section Expressions
4355
4356@cindex expressions
4357@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4358compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4359by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4360@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4361and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4362by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4363
d4f3574e
SS
4364@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4365the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4366you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4367memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4368
c906108c
SS
4369Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4370this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4371Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4372languages.
4373
4374In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4375expressions regardless of your programming language.
4376
4377Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4378useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4379at that address in memory.
4380@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4381
4382@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4383to programming languages:
4384
4385@table @code
4386@item @@
4387@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4388@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4389
4390@item ::
4391@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4392function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4393
4394@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4395@cindex type casting memory
4396@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4397@cindex casts, to view memory
4398@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4399Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4400memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4401pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4402a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4403normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4404@end table
4405
6d2ebf8b 4406@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4407@section Program variables
4408
4409The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4410in your program.
4411
4412Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4413(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4414
4415@itemize @bullet
4416@item
4417global (or file-static)
4418@end itemize
4419
5d161b24 4420@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4421
4422@itemize @bullet
4423@item
4424visible according to the scope rules of the
4425programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4426@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4427
4428@noindent This means that in the function
4429
4430@example
4431foo (a)
4432 int a;
4433@{
4434 bar (a);
4435 @{
4436 int b = test ();
4437 bar (b);
4438 @}
4439@}
4440@end example
4441
4442@noindent
4443you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4444executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4445examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4446the block where @code{b} is declared.
4447
4448@cindex variable name conflict
4449There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4450scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4451in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4452function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4453happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4454you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4455using the colon-colon notation:
4456
d4f3574e 4457@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4458@iftex
4459@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4460@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4461@end iftex
4462@example
4463@var{file}::@var{variable}
4464@var{function}::@var{variable}
4465@end example
4466
4467@noindent
4468Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4469static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4470make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4471to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4472
4473@example
4474(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4475@end example
4476
c906108c
SS
4477@cindex C++ scope resolution
4478This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4479use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4480scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4481@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4482@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4483
4484@cindex wrong values
4485@cindex variable values, wrong
4486@quotation
4487@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4488wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4489scope, and just before exit.
4490@end quotation
4491You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4492This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4493set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4494stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4495values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4496also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4497after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4498variable definitions may be gone.
4499
4500This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4501To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4502when compiling.
4503
d4f3574e
SS
4504@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4505Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4506unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4507opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4508offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4509might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4510happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4511
4512@example
4513No symbol "foo" in current context.
4514@end example
4515
4516To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4517different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4518formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4519supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4520in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4521to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4522debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4523Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4524information.
4525
4526
6d2ebf8b 4527@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4528@section Artificial arrays
4529
4530@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4531@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4532It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4533same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4534dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4535program.
4536
4537You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4538@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4539operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4540and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4541of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4542the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4543argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4544following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4545example. If a program says
4546
4547@example
4548int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4549@end example
4550
4551@noindent
4552you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4553
4554@example
4555p *array@@len
4556@end example
4557
4558The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4559with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4560subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4561Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4562(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4563
4564Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4565This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4566The value need not be in memory:
4567@example
4568(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4569$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4570@end example
4571
4572As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4573@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4574the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4575@example
4576(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4577$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4578@end example
4579
4580Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4581moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4582actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4583of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4584to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4585variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4586interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4587instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4588structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4589in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4590
4591@example
4592set $i = 0
4593p dtab[$i++]->fv
4594@key{RET}
4595@key{RET}
4596@dots{}
4597@end example
4598
6d2ebf8b 4599@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4600@section Output formats
4601
4602@cindex formatted output
4603@cindex output formats
4604By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4605this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4606in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4607at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4608these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4609
4610The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4611already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4612@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4613letters supported are:
4614
4615@table @code
4616@item x
4617Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4618hexadecimal.
4619
4620@item d
4621Print as integer in signed decimal.
4622
4623@item u
4624Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4625
4626@item o
4627Print as integer in octal.
4628
4629@item t
4630Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4631@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4632used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4633see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4634
4635@item a
4636@cindex unknown address, locating
4637Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4638the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4639where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4640
4641@example
4642(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4643$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4644@end example
4645
4646@item c
4647Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4648
4649@item f
4650Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4651using typical floating point syntax.
4652@end table
4653
4654For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4655
4656@example
4657p/x $pc
4658@end example
4659
4660@noindent
4661Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4662names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4663
4664To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4665you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4666expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4667
6d2ebf8b 4668@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4669@section Examining memory
4670
4671You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4672any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4673
4674@cindex examining memory
4675@table @code
41afff9a 4676@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4677@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4678@itemx x @var{addr}
4679@itemx x
4680Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4681@end table
4682
4683@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4684much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4685expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4686If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4687Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4688
4689@table @r
4690@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4691The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4692how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4693@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4694@c 4.1.2.
4695
4696@item @var{f}, the display format
4697The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4698@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4699The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4700The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4701
4702@item @var{u}, the unit size
4703The unit size is any of
4704
4705@table @code
4706@item b
4707Bytes.
4708@item h
4709Halfwords (two bytes).
4710@item w
4711Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4712@item g
4713Giant words (eight bytes).
4714@end table
4715
4716Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4717default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4718@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4719
4720@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4721@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4722memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4723it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4724@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4725@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4726other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4727the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4728starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4729a value from memory).
4730@end table
4731
4732For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4733(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4734starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4735words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4736@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4737
4738Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4739letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4740unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4741specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4742(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4743
4744Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4745and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4746@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4747including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4748alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4749Code,,Source and machine code}.
4750
4751All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4752easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4753you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4754instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4755with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4756the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4757for successive uses of @code{x}.
4758
4759@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4760The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4761in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4762would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4763subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4764@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4765examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4766@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4767the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4768
4769If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4770are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4771address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4772
6d2ebf8b 4773@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4774@section Automatic display
4775@cindex automatic display
4776@cindex display of expressions
4777
4778If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4779(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4780display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4781Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4782to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4783The automatic display looks like this:
4784
4785@example
47862: foo = 38
47873: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4788@end example
4789
4790@noindent
4791This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4792displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4793specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4794whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4795format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4796or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4797supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4798
4799@table @code
4800@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4801@item display @var{expr}
4802Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4803each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4804
4805@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4806
d4f3574e 4807@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4808For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4809count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4810arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4811@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4812
4813@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4814For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4815number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4816be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4817doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4818@end table
4819
4820For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4821instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4822is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4823
4824@table @code
4825@kindex delete display
4826@kindex undisplay
4827@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4828@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4829Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4830
4831@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4832(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4833
4834@kindex disable display
4835@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4836Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4837item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4838enabled again later.
4839
4840@kindex enable display
4841@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4842Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4843again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4844
4845@item display
4846Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4847done when your program stops.
4848
4849@kindex info display
4850@item info display
4851Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4852automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4853values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4854It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4855because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4856@end table
4857
4858If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4859sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4860expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4861variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4862@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4863@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4864continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4865there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4866automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4867is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4868
6d2ebf8b 4869@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4870@section Print settings
4871
4872@cindex format options
4873@cindex print settings
4874@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4875and symbols are printed.
4876
4877@noindent
4878These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4879
4880@table @code
4881@kindex set print address
4882@item set print address
4883@itemx set print address on
4884@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4885traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4886even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4887is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4888@code{set print address on}:
4889
4890@smallexample
4891@group
4892(@value{GDBP}) f
4893#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4894 at input.c:530
4895530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4896@end group
4897@end smallexample
4898
4899@item set print address off
4900Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4901this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4902
4903@smallexample
4904@group
4905(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4906(@value{GDBP}) f
4907#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4908530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4909@end group
4910@end smallexample
4911
4912You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4913dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4914@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4915all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4916
4917@kindex show print address
4918@item show print address
4919Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4920@end table
4921
4922When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4923closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4924identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4925source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4926@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4927you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4928it prints a symbolic address:
4929
4930@table @code
4931@kindex set print symbol-filename
4932@item set print symbol-filename on
4933Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4934symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4935
4936@item set print symbol-filename off
4937Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4938default.
4939
4940@kindex show print symbol-filename
4941@item show print symbol-filename
4942Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4943line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4944@end table
4945
4946Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4947numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4948number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4949
4950Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4951printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4952
4953@table @code
4954@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4955@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4956Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4957offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4958@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4959to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4960
4961@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4962@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4963Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4964symbolic address.
4965@end table
4966
4967@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4968@cindex pointer, finding referent
4969If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4970@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4971and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4972@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4973For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4974at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4975
4976@example
4977(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4978(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4979$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4980@end example
4981
4982@quotation
4983@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4984does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4985the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4986@end quotation
4987
4988Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4989
4990@table @code
4991@kindex set print array
4992@item set print array
4993@itemx set print array on
4994Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4995but uses more space. The default is off.
4996
4997@item set print array off
4998Return to compressed format for arrays.
4999
5000@kindex show print array
5001@item show print array
5002Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5003arrays.
5004
5005@kindex set print elements
5006@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5007Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5008If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5009printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5010This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5011When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5012Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5013
5014@kindex show print elements
5015@item show print elements
5016Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5017If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5018
5019@kindex set print null-stop
5020@item set print null-stop
5021Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5022@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5023contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5024The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5025
5026@kindex set print pretty
5027@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5028Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5029per line, like this:
5030
5031@smallexample
5032@group
5033$1 = @{
5034 next = 0x0,
5035 flags = @{
5036 sweet = 1,
5037 sour = 1
5038 @},
5039 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5040@}
5041@end group
5042@end smallexample
5043
5044@item set print pretty off
5045Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5046
5047@smallexample
5048@group
5049$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5050meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5051@end group
5052@end smallexample
5053
5054@noindent
5055This is the default format.
5056
5057@kindex show print pretty
5058@item show print pretty
5059Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5060
5061@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5062@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5063Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5064@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5065character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5066best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5067high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5068
5069@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5070Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5071international character sets, and is the default.
5072
5073@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5074@item show print sevenbit-strings
5075Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5076
5077@kindex set print union
5078@item set print union on
5d161b24 5079Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5080is the default setting.
5081
5082@item set print union off
5083Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5084
5085@kindex show print union
5086@item show print union
5087Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5088structures.
5089
5090For example, given the declarations
5091
5092@smallexample
5093typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5094typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5095typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5096 Bug_forms;
5097
5098struct thing @{
5099 Species it;
5100 union @{
5101 Tree_forms tree;
5102 Bug_forms bug;
5103 @} form;
5104@};
5105
5106struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5107@end smallexample
5108
5109@noindent
5110with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5111
5112@smallexample
5113$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5114@end smallexample
5115
5116@noindent
5117and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5118
5119@smallexample
5120$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5121@end smallexample
5122@end table
5123
c906108c
SS
5124@need 1000
5125@noindent
5126These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
5127
5128@table @code
5129@cindex demangling
5130@kindex set print demangle
5131@item set print demangle
5132@itemx set print demangle on
5133Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5134(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5135linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5136
5137@kindex show print demangle
5138@item show print demangle
5139Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5140
5141@kindex set print asm-demangle
5142@item set print asm-demangle
5143@itemx set print asm-demangle on
5144Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5145in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5146The default is off.
5147
5148@kindex show print asm-demangle
5149@item show print asm-demangle
5150Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5151or demangled form.
5152
5153@kindex set demangle-style
5154@cindex C++ symbol decoding style
5155@cindex symbol decoding style, C++
5156@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5157Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5158represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5159
5160@table @code
5161@item auto
5162Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5163
5164@item gnu
5d161b24 5165Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5166This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5167
5168@item hp
5169Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5170
5171@item lucid
5172Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5173
5174@item arm
5175Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
5176@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5177debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5178require further enhancement to permit that.
5179
5180@end table
5181If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5182
5183@kindex show demangle-style
5184@item show demangle-style
5185Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
5186
5187@kindex set print object
5188@item set print object
5189@itemx set print object on
5190When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5191(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5192the virtual function table.
5193
5194@item set print object off
5195Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5196virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5197
5198@kindex show print object
5199@item show print object
5200Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5201
5202@kindex set print static-members
5203@item set print static-members
5204@itemx set print static-members on
5205Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
5206
5207@item set print static-members off
5208Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
5209
5210@kindex show print static-members
5211@item show print static-members
5212Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
5213
5214@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5215@kindex set print vtbl
5216@item set print vtbl
5217@itemx set print vtbl on
5218Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5219(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5220ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5221
5222@item set print vtbl off
5223Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
5224
5225@kindex show print vtbl
5226@item show print vtbl
5227Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5228@end table
c906108c 5229
6d2ebf8b 5230@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5231@section Value history
5232
5233@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5234Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5235@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5236Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5237(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5238When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5239since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5240symbol table.
5241
5242@cindex @code{$}
5243@cindex @code{$$}
5244@cindex history number
5245The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5246refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5247@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5248printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5249history number.
5250
5251To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5252history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5253remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5254the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5255@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5256is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5257@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5258
5259For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5260want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5261
5262@example
5263p *$
5264@end example
5265
5266If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5267to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5268
5269@example
5270p *$.next
5271@end example
5272
5273@noindent
5274You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5275command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5276
5277Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5278@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5279
5280@example
5281print x
5282set x=5
5283@end example
5284
5285@noindent
5286then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5287remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5288
5289@table @code
5290@kindex show values
5291@item show values
5292Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5293This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5294values} does not change the history.
5295
5296@item show values @var{n}
5297Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5298
5299@item show values +
5300Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5301values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5302@end table
5303
5304Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5305same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5306
6d2ebf8b 5307@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5308@section Convenience variables
5309
5310@cindex convenience variables
5311@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5312@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5313exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5314setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5315of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5316
5317Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5318@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5319the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5320(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5321by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5322
5323You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5324expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5325For example:
5326
5327@example
5328set $foo = *object_ptr
5329@end example
5330
5331@noindent
5332would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5333@code{object_ptr}.
5334
5335Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5336value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5337value with another assignment at any time.
5338
5339Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5340variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5341that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5342variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5343
5344@table @code
5345@kindex show convenience
5346@item show convenience
5347Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5348Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5349@end table
5350
5351One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5352incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5353a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5354
5355@example
5356set $i = 0
5357print bar[$i++]->contents
5358@end example
5359
d4f3574e
SS
5360@noindent
5361Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5362
5363Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5364values likely to be useful.
5365
5366@table @code
41afff9a 5367@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5368@item $_
5369The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5370the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5371commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5372set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5373and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5374except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5375to the type of @code{$__}.
5376
41afff9a 5377@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5378@item $__
5379The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5380to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5381to match the format in which the data was printed.
5382
5383@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5384@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5385The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5386the program being debugged terminates.
5387@end table
5388
53a5351d
JM
5389On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5390begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5391name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5392
6d2ebf8b 5393@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5394@section Registers
5395
5396@cindex registers
5397You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5398with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5399for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5400your machine.
5401
5402@table @code
5403@kindex info registers
5404@item info registers
5405Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5406registers (in the selected stack frame).
5407
5408@kindex info all-registers
5409@cindex floating point registers
5410@item info all-registers
5411Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5412registers.
5413
5414@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5415Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5416As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5417the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5418the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5419@end table
5420
5421@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5422expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5423architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5424@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5425the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5426pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5427register that contains the processor status. For example,
5428you could print the program counter in hex with
5429
5430@example
5431p/x $pc
5432@end example
5433
5434@noindent
5435or print the instruction to be executed next with
5436
5437@example
5438x/i $pc
5439@end example
5440
5441@noindent
5442or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5443one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5444memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5445stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5446stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5447regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5448see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5449
5450@example
5451set $sp += 4
5452@end example
5453
5454Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5455your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5456so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5457shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5458registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5459can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5460is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5461
5462@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5463integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5464special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5465registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5466to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5467(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5468@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5469
5470Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5471means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5472the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5473sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5474coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5475programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5476cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5477that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5478prints the data in both formats.
5479
5480Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5481(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5482value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5483were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5484true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5485frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5486
5487However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5488code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5489@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5490frame makes no difference.
5491
6d2ebf8b 5492@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5493@section Floating point hardware
5494@cindex floating point
5495
5496Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5497you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5498
5499@table @code
5500@kindex info float
5501@item info float
5502Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5503point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5504floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5505the ARM and x86 machines.
5506@end table
c906108c 5507
29e57380
C
5508@node Memory Region Attributes
5509@section Memory Region Attributes
5510@cindex memory region attributes
5511
5512@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5513required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5514to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5515use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5516
5517Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5518memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5519accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5520been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5521all memory.
5522
5523When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5524to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5525
5526@table @code
5527@kindex mem
5528@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5529Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5530with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5531
5532@kindex delete mem
5533@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5534Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5535
5536@kindex disable mem
5537@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5538Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5539A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5540It may be enabled again later.
5541
5542@kindex enable mem
5543@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5544Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5545
5546@kindex info mem
5547@item info mem
5548Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5549for each region.
5550
5551@table @emph
5552@item Memory Region Number
5553@item Enabled or Disabled.
5554Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5555Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5556
5557@item Lo Address
5558The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5559
5560@item Hi Address
5561The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5562
5563@item Attributes
5564The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5565@end table
5566@end table
5567
5568
5569@subsection Attributes
5570
5571@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5572The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5573write accesses to a memory region.
5574
5575While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5576memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5577etc. from accessing memory.
5578
5579@table @code
5580@item ro
5581Memory is read only.
5582@item wo
5583Memory is write only.
5584@item rw
5585Memory is read/write (default).
5586@end table
5587
5588@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5589The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5590accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5591require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5592specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5593
5594@table @code
5595@item 8
5596Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5597@item 16
5598Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5599@item 32
5600Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5601@item 64
5602Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5603@end table
5604
5605@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5606@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5607@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5608@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5609@c
5610@c @table @code
5611@c @item hwbreak
5612@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5613@c @item swbreak (default)
5614@c @end table
5615
5616@subsubsection Data Cache
5617The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5618memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5619protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5620does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5621registers.
5622
5623@table @code
5624@item cache
5625Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5626@item nocache (default)
5627Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5628@end table
5629
5630@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5631@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5632@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5633@c
5634@c @table @code
5635@c @item verify
5636@c @item noverify (default)
5637@c @end table
5638
6d2ebf8b 5639@node Languages
c906108c
SS
5640@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5641@cindex languages
5642
c906108c
SS
5643Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5644rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5645dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5646Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 5647represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 5648@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
5649
5650@cindex working language
5651Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5652allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5653native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5654consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5655language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5656language}.
5657
5658@menu
5659* Setting:: Switching between source languages
5660* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 5661* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5662* Support:: Supported languages
5663@end menu
5664
6d2ebf8b 5665@node Setting
c906108c
SS
5666@section Switching between source languages
5667
5668There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5669set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5670@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5671defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5672used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5673are printed, etc.
5674
5675In addition to the working language, every source file that
5676@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5677file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5678source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5679language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5680controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5681show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
5682set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5683set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5684Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
5685
5686This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 5687as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
5688another language. In that case, make the
5689program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5690@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5691program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5692
5693@menu
5694* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5695* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5696* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5697@end menu
5698
6d2ebf8b 5699@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
5700@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5701
5702If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5703@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5704
5705@table @file
5706
5707@item .c
5708C source file
5709
5710@item .C
5711@itemx .cc
5712@itemx .cp
5713@itemx .cpp
5714@itemx .cxx
5715@itemx .c++
5716C++ source file
5717
5718@item .f
5719@itemx .F
5720Fortran source file
5721
c906108c
SS
5722@item .ch
5723@itemx .c186
5724@itemx .c286
96a2c332 5725CHILL source file
c906108c 5726
c906108c
SS
5727@item .mod
5728Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
5729
5730@item .s
5731@itemx .S
5732Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5733@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5734@end table
5735
5736In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5737extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5738
6d2ebf8b 5739@node Manually
c906108c
SS
5740@subsection Setting the working language
5741
5742If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5743expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5744your program.
5745
5746@kindex set language
5747If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5748command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 5749a language, such as
c906108c 5750@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
5751For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5752
c906108c
SS
5753Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5754language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5755to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5756source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5757languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5758source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5759command such as:
5760
5761@example
5762print a = b + c
5763@end example
5764
5765@noindent
5766might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5767@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5768printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5769@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 5770
6d2ebf8b 5771@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
5772@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5773
5774To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5775@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5776then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5777frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5778working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5779frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5780or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5781does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5782not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5783
5784This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5785entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5786written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5787a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5788case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5789
6d2ebf8b 5790@node Show
c906108c 5791@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
5792
5793The following commands help you find out which language is the
5794working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5795
5796@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
5797@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5798@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
5799@table @code
5800@item show language
5801Display the current working language. This is the
5802language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5803build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5804
5805@item info frame
5d161b24 5806Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 5807working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 5808@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
5809information listed here.
5810
5811@item info source
5812Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 5813@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
5814information listed here.
5815@end table
5816
5817In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5818not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5819with a language explicitly:
5820
5821@kindex set extension-language
5822@kindex info extensions
5823@table @code
5824@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5825Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5826the source language @var{language}.
5827
5828@item info extensions
5829List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5830@end table
5831
6d2ebf8b 5832@node Checks
c906108c
SS
5833@section Type and range checking
5834
5835@quotation
5836@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5837checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5838section documents the intended facilities.
5839@end quotation
5840@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5841
5842Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5843errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5844checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5845sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5846these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5847by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5848errors when your program is running.
5849
5850@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5851Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5852can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5853the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5854@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5855your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5856for the default settings of supported languages.
5857
5858@menu
5859* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5860* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5861@end menu
5862
5863@cindex type checking
5864@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 5865@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
5866@subsection An overview of type checking
5867
5868Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5869arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5870otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5871errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5872
5873@smallexample
58741 + 2 @result{} 3
5875@exdent but
5876@error{} 1 + 2.3
5877@end smallexample
5878
5879The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5880type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5881
5d161b24
DB
5882For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5883@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5884to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5885or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
5886but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5887these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5888also issues a warning.
5889
5d161b24
DB
5890Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5891related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5892For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5893a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5894with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
5895the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5896
5897Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5898instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5899operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5900represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5901operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5902details on specific languages.
5903
5904@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5905
d4f3574e 5906@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
5907@kindex set check type
5908@kindex show check type
5909@table @code
5910@item set check type auto
5911Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5912@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5913each language.
5914
5915@item set check type on
5916@itemx set check type off
5917Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5918current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5919match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 5920evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
5921message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5922
5923@item set check type warn
5924Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5925evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5926be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5927numbers and structures.
5928
5929@item show type
5d161b24 5930Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5931is setting it automatically.
5932@end table
5933
5934@cindex range checking
5935@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 5936@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
5937@subsection An overview of range checking
5938
5939In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5940bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5941checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5942computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5943not exceed the bounds of the array.
5944
5945For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5946@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5947always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5948warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5949
5950A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5951array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5952of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5953error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5954result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5955the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5956
5957@example
5958@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5959@end example
5960
5961This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5962specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5963Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5964
5965@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5966
d4f3574e 5967@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
5968@kindex set check range
5969@kindex show check range
5970@table @code
5971@item set check range auto
5972Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5973@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5974each language.
5975
5976@item set check range on
5977@itemx set check range off
5978Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5979current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
5980match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5981then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
5982
5983@item set check range warn
5984Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5985but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5986expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5987memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5988systems).
5989
5990@item show range
5991Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5992being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5993@end table
c906108c 5994
6d2ebf8b 5995@node Support
c906108c 5996@section Supported languages
c906108c 5997
cce74817
JM
5998@value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5999@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
6000Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6001language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6002and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6003,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6004language.
6005
6006The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6007supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6008tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6009@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6010formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6011books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6012language reference or tutorial.
6013
c906108c 6014@menu
7a292a7a 6015* C:: C and C++
cce74817 6016* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 6017* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
6018@end menu
6019
6d2ebf8b 6020@node C
c906108c 6021@subsection C and C++
7a292a7a 6022
c906108c
SS
6023@cindex C and C++
6024@cindex expressions in C or C++
c906108c
SS
6025
6026Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
6027to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6028together.
6029
41afff9a
EZ
6030@cindex C@t{++}
6031@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
c906108c
SS
6032@cindex @sc{gnu} C++
6033The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
6034compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
6035effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
6036C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
6037compiler (@code{aCC}).
6038
6039For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
6040format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6041command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6042@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6043CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 6044
c906108c
SS
6045@menu
6046* C Operators:: C and C++ operators
6047* C Constants:: C and C++ constants
7a292a7a 6048* C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
c906108c 6049* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
c906108c 6050* C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6051* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
6052* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
6053@end menu
c906108c 6054
6d2ebf8b 6055@node C Operators
c906108c 6056@subsubsection C and C++ operators
7a292a7a
SS
6057
6058@cindex C and C++ operators
c906108c
SS
6059
6060Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6061@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 6062often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 6063
c906108c 6064For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
6065
6066@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 6067
c906108c 6068@item
c906108c
SS
6069@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
6070specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
6071
6072@item
d4f3574e
SS
6073@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6074@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
6075
6076@item
53a5351d 6077@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
6078
6079@item
6080@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 6081
c906108c
SS
6082@end itemize
6083
6084@noindent
6085The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6086in order of increasing precedence:
6087
6088@table @code
6089@item ,
6090The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6091are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6092expression being the last expression evaluated.
6093
6094@item =
6095Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6096assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6097
6098@item @var{op}=
6099Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6100and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 6101@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
6102@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6103@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6104
6105@item ?:
6106The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6107of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6108integral type.
6109
6110@item ||
6111Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6112
6113@item &&
6114Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6115
6116@item |
6117Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6118
6119@item ^
6120Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6121
6122@item &
6123Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6124
6125@item ==@r{, }!=
6126Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6127expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6128
6129@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6130Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6131Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6132and non-zero for true.
6133
6134@item <<@r{, }>>
6135left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6136
6137@item @@
6138The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6139
6140@item +@r{, }-
6141Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6142pointer types.
6143
6144@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6145Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6146defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6147integral types.
6148
6149@item ++@r{, }--
6150Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6151operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6152when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6153operation takes place.
6154
6155@item *
6156Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6157@code{++}.
6158
6159@item &
6160Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6161
c906108c
SS
6162For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6163allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
6164(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
6165where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
6166stored.
c906108c
SS
6167
6168@item -
6169Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6170precedence as @code{++}.
6171
6172@item !
6173Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6174@code{++}.
6175
6176@item ~
6177Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6178@code{++}.
6179
6180
6181@item .@r{, }->
6182Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6183@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6184pointer based on the stored type information.
6185Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6186
c906108c
SS
6187@item .*@r{, }->*
6188Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6189
6190@item []
6191Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6192@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6193
6194@item ()
6195Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6196
c906108c 6197@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6198C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
6199and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6200
6201@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6202Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6203(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6204above.
c906108c
SS
6205@end table
6206
c906108c
SS
6207If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6208attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6209predefined meaning.
c906108c 6210
c906108c 6211@menu
5d161b24 6212* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6213@end menu
6214
6d2ebf8b 6215@node C Constants
c906108c 6216@subsubsection C and C++ constants
c906108c
SS
6217
6218@cindex C and C++ constants
c906108c 6219
7a292a7a 6220@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
c906108c 6221following ways:
c906108c
SS
6222
6223@itemize @bullet
6224@item
6225Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6226specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6227a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6228@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6229@code{long} value.
6230
6231@item
6232Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6233point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6234exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6235@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6236sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6237A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6238@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6239the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6240a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6241constant.
c906108c
SS
6242
6243@item
6244Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6245integral equivalents.
6246
6247@item
6248Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6249(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6250(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6251be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6252the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6253of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6254@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6255@samp{\n} for newline.
6256
6257@item
96a2c332
SS
6258String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6259double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6260above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6261a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6262characters.
c906108c
SS
6263
6264@item
6265Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6266to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6267
6268@item
6269Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6270and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6271integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6272and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6273@end itemize
6274
c906108c 6275@menu
5d161b24
DB
6276* C plus plus expressions::
6277* C Defaults::
6278* C Checks::
c906108c 6279
5d161b24 6280* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6281@end menu
6282
6d2ebf8b 6283@node C plus plus expressions
c906108c 6284@subsubsection C++ expressions
c906108c
SS
6285
6286@cindex expressions in C++
6287@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
6288
c906108c
SS
6289@cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
6290@cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
6291@cindex C++ and object formats
6292@cindex object formats and C++
6293@cindex a.out and C++
6294@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
6295@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
6296@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
6297@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
6298@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6299@c periodically whether this has happened...
6300@quotation
6301@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
6302proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
6303additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6304special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6305@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6306symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6307you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6308extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
6309@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
6310support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6311@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6312
6313@enumerate
6314
6315@cindex member functions
6316@item
6317Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6318
6319@example
6320count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6321@end example
6322
41afff9a 6323@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
c906108c
SS
6324@cindex namespace in C++
6325@item
6326While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6327expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6328that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6329pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
6330
c906108c 6331@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6332@cindex overloaded functions, calling
c906108c
SS
6333@cindex type conversions in C++
6334@item
6335You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6336call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6337perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6338calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6339in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6340default arguments.
6341
6342It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6343promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6344class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6345functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6346number of function arguments.
6347
6348Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6349@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6350,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
6351
d4f3574e 6352You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6353explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6354@smallexample
6355p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6356@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6357
c906108c 6358The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6359see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6360
c906108c
SS
6361@cindex reference declarations
6362@item
5d161b24 6363@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
c906108c
SS
6364them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6365dereferenced.
6366
6367In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6368reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6369avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6370The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6371you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6372
6373@item
6374@value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6375expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6376one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6377necessary, for example in an expression like
6378@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6379resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6380debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6381@end enumerate
6382
53a5351d
JM
6383In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6384calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6385objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6386invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 6387
6d2ebf8b 6388@node C Defaults
c906108c 6389@subsubsection C and C++ defaults
7a292a7a 6390
c906108c
SS
6391@cindex C and C++ defaults
6392
c906108c
SS
6393If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6394both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6395C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6396selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
6397
6398If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6399recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6400@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6401these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6402@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6403for further details.
6404
c906108c
SS
6405@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6406@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6407@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 6408
6d2ebf8b 6409@node C Checks
c906108c 6410@subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
7a292a7a 6411
c906108c
SS
6412@cindex C and C++ checks
6413
6414By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6415is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6416considers two variables type equivalent if:
6417
6418@itemize @bullet
6419@item
6420The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6421enumerated tag.
6422
6423@item
6424The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6425declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6426
6427@ignore
6428@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6429@c FIXME--beers?
6430@item
6431The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6432declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6433compilers.)
6434@end ignore
6435@end itemize
6436
6437Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6438indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6439that is not itself an array.
c906108c 6440
6d2ebf8b 6441@node Debugging C
c906108c 6442@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
6443
6444The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6445the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
6446inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6447appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
6448
6449The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6450with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6451,Expressions}.
6452
c906108c 6453@menu
5d161b24 6454* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
6455@end menu
6456
6d2ebf8b 6457@node Debugging C plus plus
c906108c 6458@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
c906108c
SS
6459
6460@cindex commands for C++
7a292a7a 6461
c906108c
SS
6462Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6463designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6464
6465@table @code
6466@cindex break in overloaded functions
6467@item @r{breakpoint menus}
6468When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6469@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6470you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6471
6472@cindex overloading in C++
6473@item rbreak @var{regex}
6474Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6475breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6476classes.
6477@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6478
6479@cindex C++ exception handling
6480@item catch throw
6481@itemx catch catch
6482Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6483Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6484
6485@cindex inheritance
6486@item ptype @var{typename}
6487Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6488@var{typename}.
6489@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6490
6491@cindex C++ symbol display
6492@item set print demangle
6493@itemx show print demangle
6494@itemx set print asm-demangle
6495@itemx show print asm-demangle
6496Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6497displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6498@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6499
6500@item set print object
6501@itemx show print object
6502Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6503@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6504
6505@item set print vtbl
6506@itemx show print vtbl
6507Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6508@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c
SS
6509(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6510ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6511
6512@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 6513@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c
SS
6514@item set overload-resolution on
6515Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6516is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6517and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
d4f3574e
SS
6518using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6519expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
6520message.
6521
6522@item set overload-resolution off
6523Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6524overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6525chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6526symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6527overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6528searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6529argument types.
c906108c
SS
6530
6531@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6532You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6533the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6534@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6535also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6536available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6537@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6538@end table
c906108c 6539
6d2ebf8b 6540@node Modula-2
c906108c 6541@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 6542
d4f3574e 6543@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
6544
6545The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6546output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6547developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6548attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6549to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6550table.
6551
6552@cindex expressions in Modula-2
6553@menu
6554* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6555* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6556* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6557* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6558* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6559* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6560* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6561* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6562@end menu
6563
6d2ebf8b 6564@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
6565@subsubsection Operators
6566@cindex Modula-2 operators
6567
6568Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6569@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6570often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6571following definitions hold:
6572
6573@itemize @bullet
6574
6575@item
6576@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6577their subranges.
6578
6579@item
6580@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6581
6582@item
6583@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6584
6585@item
6586@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6587@var{type}}.
6588
6589@item
6590@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6591
6592@item
6593@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6594
6595@item
6596@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6597@end itemize
6598
6599@noindent
6600The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6601increasing precedence:
6602
6603@table @code
6604@item ,
6605Function argument or array index separator.
6606
6607@item :=
6608Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6609@var{value}.
6610
6611@item <@r{, }>
6612Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6613types.
6614
6615@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 6616Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
6617on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6618set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6619
6620@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6621Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6622Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6623available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6624comment character.
6625
6626@item IN
6627Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6628Same precedence as @code{<}.
6629
6630@item OR
6631Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6632
6633@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 6634Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
6635
6636@item @@
6637The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6638
6639@item +@r{, }-
6640Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6641and difference on set types.
6642
6643@item *
6644Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6645on set types.
6646
6647@item /
6648Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6649types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6650
6651@item DIV@r{, }MOD
6652Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6653precedence as @code{*}.
6654
6655@item -
6656Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6657
6658@item ^
6659Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6660
6661@item NOT
6662Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6663@code{^}.
6664
6665@item .
6666@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6667precedence as @code{^}.
6668
6669@item []
6670Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6671
6672@item ()
6673Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6674as @code{^}.
6675
6676@item ::@r{, }.
6677@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6678@end table
6679
6680@quotation
6681@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6682treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6683@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6684@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6685@end quotation
6686
6687@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6d2ebf8b 6688@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
6689@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6690
6691Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6692In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6693
6694@table @var
6695
6696@item a
6697represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6698
6699@item c
6700represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6701
6702@item i
6703represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6704
6705@item m
6706represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6707same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6708be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6709
6710@item n
6711represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6712
6713@item r
6714represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6715
6716@item t
6717represents a type.
6718
6719@item v
6720represents a variable.
6721
6722@item x
6723represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6724explanation of the function for details.
6725@end table
6726
6727All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6728
6729@table @code
6730@item ABS(@var{n})
6731Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6732
6733@item CAP(@var{c})
6734If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 6735equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
6736
6737@item CHR(@var{i})
6738Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6739
6740@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6741Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6742
6743@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6744Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6745new value.
6746
6747@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6748Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6749set.
6750
6751@item FLOAT(@var{i})
6752Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6753
6754@item HIGH(@var{a})
6755Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6756
6757@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6758Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6759
6760@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6761Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6762new value.
6763
6764@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6765Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6766there. Returns the new set.
6767
6768@item MAX(@var{t})
6769Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6770
6771@item MIN(@var{t})
6772Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6773
6774@item ODD(@var{i})
6775Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6776
6777@item ORD(@var{x})
6778Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
6779value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6780@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
6781integral, character and enumerated types.
6782
6783@item SIZE(@var{x})
6784Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6785
6786@item TRUNC(@var{r})
6787Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6788
6789@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6790Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6791@end table
6792
6793@quotation
6794@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6795@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6796an error.
6797@end quotation
6798
6799@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 6800@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
6801@subsubsection Constants
6802
6803@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6804ways:
6805
6806@itemize @bullet
6807
6808@item
6809Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6810expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6811rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6812trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6813
6814@item
6815Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6816decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6817then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6818@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6819digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6820digits.
6821
6822@item
6823Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6824like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 6825also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
6826followed by a @samp{C}.
6827
6828@item
6829String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6830pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6831Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6832Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6833sequences.
6834
6835@item
6836Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6837
6838@item
6839Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6840@code{FALSE}.
6841
6842@item
6843Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6844
6845@item
6846Set constants are not yet supported.
6847@end itemize
6848
6d2ebf8b 6849@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
6850@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6851@cindex Modula-2 defaults
6852
6853If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6854both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 6855Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6856selected the working language.
6857
6858If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6859code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 6860working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
6861the language automatically}, for further details.
6862
6d2ebf8b 6863@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
6864@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6865@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6866
6867A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6868This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6869
6870@itemize @bullet
6871@item
6872Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6873integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6874debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6875pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6876through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6877returned a pointer.)
6878
6879@item
6880C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6881non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6882escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6883printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6884
6885@item
6886The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6887argument.
6888
6889@item
6890All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6891@end itemize
6892
6d2ebf8b 6893@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
6894@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6895@cindex Modula-2 checks
6896
6897@quotation
6898@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6899range checking.
6900@end quotation
6901@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6902
6903@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6904
6905@itemize @bullet
6906@item
6907They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6908@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6909
6910@item
6911They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6912@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6913@end itemize
6914
6915As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6916whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6917
6918Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6919index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6920
6d2ebf8b 6921@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
6922@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6923@cindex scope
41afff9a 6924@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
6925@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6926@ifinfo
41afff9a 6927@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6928@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6929@end ifinfo
6930@iftex
41afff9a 6931@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6932@end iftex
6933
6934There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6935(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6936similar syntax:
6937
6938@example
6939
6940@var{module} . @var{id}
6941@var{scope} :: @var{id}
6942@end example
6943
6944@noindent
6945where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6946@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6947identifier within your program, except another module.
6948
6949Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6950specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6951found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6952enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6953
6954Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6955the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6956definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6957an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6958module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6959@var{module}.
6960
6d2ebf8b 6961@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
6962@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6963
6964Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6965Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6966specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6967@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6968apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6969analogue in Modula-2.
6970
6971The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 6972with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c
SS
6973intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6974created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6975address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 6976@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
6977
6978@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6979In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6980interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 6981
6d2ebf8b 6982@node Chill
cce74817
JM
6983@subsection Chill
6984
6985The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 6986from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
6987supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6988likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6989table.
6990
d4f3574e
SS
6991@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6992@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6993This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
6994of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6995
6996@menu
104c1213
JM
6997* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6998* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 6999* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 7000* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 7001* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
7002@end menu
7003
6d2ebf8b 7004@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
7005@subsubsection How modes are displayed
7006
7007The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 7008with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
7009slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7010provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
7011
7012@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7013@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
7014@table @code
7015@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7016@itemize @bullet
7017@item
7018@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7019UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7020@item
5d161b24 7021@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 7022@item
5d161b24 7023@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
7024@item
7025@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7026@smallexample
7027(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7028type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7029@end smallexample
7030If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7031@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7032@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7033@smallexample
7034@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7035@end smallexample
7036where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7037expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
7038@end itemize
7039
7040@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7041A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 7042the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
7043@smallexample
7044(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7045type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7046@end smallexample
7047
7048@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7049@itemize @bullet
7050@item
d4f3574e 7051@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
7052followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7053@item
7054@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7055@end itemize
7056
7057@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7058The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7059<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
7060list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7061the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
7062all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7063
7064@ignore
7065@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7066The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 7067type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
7068@end ignore
7069
5d161b24 7070@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7071@itemize @bullet
7072@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7073@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7074@smallexample
7075@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7076@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7077where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7078@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7079@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7080@smallexample
7081@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7082@end smallexample
7083where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
7084@end itemize
7085
5d161b24 7086@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7087@itemize @bullet
7088@item
7089@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7090@item
7091@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7092@end itemize
7093
7094@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7095Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7096
7097@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7098@itemize @bullet
7099@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7100@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7101@smallexample
7102@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7103@end smallexample
7104followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7105mode
cce74817 7106@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7107@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7108@smallexample
7109@code{BOOLS(<string
7110length>)}
7111@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7112@end itemize
7113
7114@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7115The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7116followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7117@smallexample
7118(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
7119type = ARRAY (1:42)
7120 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
7121 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7122@end smallexample
7123
5d161b24 7124@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 7125The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
7126list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7127of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7128OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
7129of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7130checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7131always displays all variant fields.
7132@smallexample
7133(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7134type = STRUCT (
7135 as x,
7136 bs x,
7137 CASE bs OF
7138 (karli):
7139 cs a
7140 (ott):
7141 ds x
7142 ESAC
7143)
7144@end smallexample
7145@end table
7146
6d2ebf8b 7147@node Locations
cce74817
JM
7148@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7149
7150A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7151
7152A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7153the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7154Chill programs. How values are specified
7155is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7156
7157The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7158display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7159
cce74817
JM
7160@smallexample
7161set result := EXPR
7162@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7163
7164@noindent
7165This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7166is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7167
7168Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7169value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7170mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7171represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7172value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7173operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7174
6d2ebf8b
SS
7175Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7176@smallexample
7177@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7178(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7179location>}
7180@end smallexample
7181@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7182specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7183the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7184
7185@ignore
7186Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7187fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7188the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7189implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7190na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7191<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7192@code{__proc_copy}.
7193
7194Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7195the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7196like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7197mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7198
7199Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7200...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7201definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7202of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7203structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7204braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7205on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7206memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7207all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7208@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7209stuff ???)
7210@smallexample
7211(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7212[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7213@end smallexample
7214@end ignore
7215
7216Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7217(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7218certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7219and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7220
7221A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7222location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7223name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7224have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7225checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7226therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7227
cce74817
JM
7228@smallexample
7229(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7230@end smallexample
7231
6d2ebf8b 7232@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7233@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7234
7235Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7236more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7237data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7238such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7239constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7240when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7241(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7242the values behind these locations.
7243
d4f3574e 7244This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7245operations are legal to be used with such values.
7246
7247@table @code
7248@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7249Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7250For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7251chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7252@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7253@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7254
5d161b24 7255@ignore
cce74817
JM
7256@itemize @bullet
7257@item
7258@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7259programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7260@item
7261@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7262@item
7263@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7264@code{'M'})
7265@item
7266@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e
SS
7267mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
7268comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
cce74817 7269@item
d4f3574e 7270@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7271emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7272procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7273
7274@item
7275@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7276enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7277to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7278@item
7279@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7280programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7281@item
7282@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7283(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7284@end itemize
7285@end ignore
7286
7287@item Tuple Values
7288A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7289name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7290unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7291@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7292
cce74817
JM
7293@itemize @bullet
7294@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7295@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7296@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7297Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7298same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7299@end itemize
7300
7301@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7302A string element value is specified by
7303@smallexample
7304@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7305@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7306where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7307value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7308the string.
7309
7310@item String Slice Value
7311A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7312spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7313expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7314@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7315The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7316string.
7317
7318@item Array Element Values
7319An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7320delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7321
7322@item Array Slice Values
7323An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7324@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7325@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7326arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7327which is part of the specified array.
7328
7329@item Structure Field Values
7330A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7331name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7332in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7333corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7334
7335@item Procedure Call Value
7336The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7337procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7338expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7339effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7340
d4f3574e 7341Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7342
6d2ebf8b
SS
7343Values of time mode locations appear as
7344@smallexample
7345@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7346@end smallexample
7347
cce74817
JM
7348
7349@ignore
7350This is not implemented yet:
7351@item Built-in Value
7352@noindent
7353The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7354
cce74817
JM
7355@table @code
7356@item @code{ADDR()}
7357@item @code{NUM()}
7358@item @code{PRED()}
7359@item @code{SUCC()}
7360@item @code{ABS()}
7361@item @code{CARD()}
7362@item @code{MAX()}
7363@item @code{MIN()}
7364@item @code{SIZE()}
7365@item @code{UPPER()}
7366@item @code{LOWER()}
7367@item @code{LENGTH()}
7368@item @code{SIN()}
7369@item @code{COS()}
7370@item @code{TAN()}
7371@item @code{ARCSIN()}
7372@item @code{ARCCOS()}
7373@item @code{ARCTAN()}
7374@item @code{EXP()}
7375@item @code{LN()}
7376@item @code{LOG()}
7377@item @code{SQRT()}
7378@end table
7379
7380For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
7381chapter 1.6.
7382@end ignore
7383
7384@item Zero-adic Operator Value
7385The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7386current active process.
7387
7388@item Expression Values
7389The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 7390the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 7391incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 7392corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 7393causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 7394which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 7395operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 7396
cce74817
JM
7397@table @code
7398@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7399@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7400@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7401Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 7402
cce74817
JM
7403@item @code{=, /=}
7404Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 7405
cce74817 7406@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7407@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7408Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7409
cce74817 7410@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 7411@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 7412Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7413
cce74817
JM
7414@item @code{-}
7415Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 7416
cce74817
JM
7417@item @code{//}
7418String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 7419
cce74817
JM
7420@item @code{()}
7421String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 7422
cce74817
JM
7423@item @code{->}
7424Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7425address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7426location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 7427
cce74817 7428@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7429@itemx @code{AND}
7430@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7431Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 7432
cce74817 7433@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7434@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7435Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 7436
cce74817
JM
7437@item @code{IN}
7438Membership operator.
7439@end table
7440@end table
7441
6d2ebf8b 7442@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
7443@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7444
7445@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 7446of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 7447complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 7448equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
7449structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7450
7451Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7452index bounds and all built in procedures.
7453
7454Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 7455check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
7456operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7457functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7458language specification.
7459
cce74817
JM
7460All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7461off}.
7462
5d161b24 7463@ignore
53a5351d 7464@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
7465see last paragraph ?
7466@end ignore
7467
6d2ebf8b 7468@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
7469@subsubsection Chill defaults
7470
7471If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7472both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7473Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
7474selected the working language.
7475
7476If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7477code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 7478working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
7479the language automatically}, for further details.
7480
6d2ebf8b 7481@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
7482@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7483
d4f3574e 7484The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
7485symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7486program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7487does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7488program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7489(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7490file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7491
7492@cindex symbol names
7493@cindex names of symbols
7494@cindex quoting names
7495Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7496characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7497most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7498source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7499are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7500ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7501@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7502@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7503
7504@example
7505p 'foo.c'::x
7506@end example
7507
7508@noindent
7509looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7510
7511@table @code
7512@kindex info address
7513@item info address @var{symbol}
7514Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7515variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7516local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7517is always stored.
7518
7519Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7520at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7521the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7522
7523@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
7524@item whatis @var{expr}
7525Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
7526actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7527assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7528@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7529
7530@item whatis
7531Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7532
7533@kindex ptype
7534@item ptype @var{typename}
7535Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
7536the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7537@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7538@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 7539
d4f3574e 7540@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 7541@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 7542Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
7543differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7544of just the name of the type.
7545
7546For example, for this variable declaration:
7547
7548@example
7549struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7550@end example
7551
7552@noindent
7553the two commands give this output:
7554
7555@example
7556@group
7557(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7558type = struct complex
7559(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7560type = struct complex @{
7561 double real;
7562 double imag;
7563@}
7564@end group
7565@end example
7566
7567@noindent
7568As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7569the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7570
7571@kindex info types
7572@item info types @var{regexp}
7573@itemx info types
d4f3574e 7574Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
7575(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7576complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7577@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 7578names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
7579information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7580
7581This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7582@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7583lists all source files where a type is defined.
7584
7585@kindex info source
7586@item info source
7587Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7588the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7589it was written in.
7590
7591@kindex info sources
7592@item info sources
7593Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7594debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7595have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7596
7597@kindex info functions
7598@item info functions
7599Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7600
7601@item info functions @var{regexp}
7602Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7603whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7604Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7605include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7606start with @code{step}.
7607
7608@kindex info variables
7609@item info variables
7610Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7611outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7612
7613@item info variables @var{regexp}
7614Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7615variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7616@var{regexp}.
7617
7618@ignore
7619This was never implemented.
7620@kindex info methods
7621@item info methods
7622@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7623The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7624methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7625specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7626C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7627from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7628@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7629which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7630@end ignore
7631
c906108c
SS
7632@cindex reloading symbols
7633Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
7634be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7635in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7636running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7637@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
7638
7639@table @code
7640@kindex set symbol-reloading
7641@item set symbol-reloading on
7642Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7643object file with a particular name is seen again.
7644
7645@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
7646Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
7647same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
7648running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
7649should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
7650may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
7651several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
7652name.
c906108c
SS
7653
7654@kindex show symbol-reloading
7655@item show symbol-reloading
7656Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7657@end table
c906108c 7658
c906108c
SS
7659@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7660@item set opaque-type-resolution on
7661Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7662declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7663@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7664source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7665another source file. The default is on.
7666
7667A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7668the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7669
7670@item set opaque-type-resolution off
7671Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7672is printed as follows:
7673@smallexample
7674@{<no data fields>@}
7675@end smallexample
7676
7677@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7678@item show opaque-type-resolution
7679Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
7680
7681@kindex maint print symbols
7682@cindex symbol dump
7683@kindex maint print psymbols
7684@cindex partial symbol dump
7685@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7686@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7687@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7688Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7689These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7690symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7691symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7692collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7693only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7694command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7695use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7696symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7697files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7698@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7699required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7700@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7701@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7702@end table
7703
6d2ebf8b 7704@node Altering
c906108c
SS
7705@chapter Altering Execution
7706
7707Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7708find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7709correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7710experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7711program.
7712
7713For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
7714locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7715address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
7716
7717@menu
7718* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7719* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 7720* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
7721* Returning:: Returning from a function
7722* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7723* Patching:: Patching your program
7724@end menu
7725
6d2ebf8b 7726@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
7727@section Assignment to variables
7728
7729@cindex assignment
7730@cindex setting variables
7731To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7732@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7733
7734@example
7735print x=4
7736@end example
7737
7738@noindent
7739stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 7740value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
7741@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7742information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
7743
7744@kindex set variable
7745@cindex variables, setting
7746If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7747@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7748really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7749not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7750,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7751
c906108c
SS
7752If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7753appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7754variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7755to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7756program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7757a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7758command @code{set width}:
7759
7760@example
7761(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7762type = double
7763(@value{GDBP}) p width
7764$4 = 13
7765(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7766Invalid syntax in expression.
7767@end example
7768
7769@noindent
7770The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7771order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7772
7773@example
7774(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7775@end example
53a5351d 7776
c906108c
SS
7777Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7778with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7779@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7780your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7781to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7782the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7783
7784@example
7785@group
7786(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7787type = double
7788(@value{GDBP}) p g
7789$1 = 1
7790(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 7791(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
7792$2 = 1
7793(@value{GDBP}) r
7794The program being debugged has been started already.
7795Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7796Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
7797"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
7798 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
7799(@value{GDBP}) show g
7800The current BFD target is "=4".
7801@end group
7802@end example
7803
7804@noindent
7805The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7806@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7807@code{g}, use
7808
7809@example
7810(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7811@end example
c906108c
SS
7812
7813@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7814freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7815and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7816same length or shorter.
7817@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7818@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7819
7820To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7821construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7822(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7823to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7824and representation in memory), and
7825
7826@example
7827set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7828@end example
7829
7830@noindent
7831stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7832
6d2ebf8b 7833@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
7834@section Continuing at a different address
7835
7836Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7837it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7838an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7839
7840@table @code
7841@kindex jump
7842@item jump @var{linespec}
7843Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7844immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7845source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7846@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7847in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7848breakpoints}.
7849
7850The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7851the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7852register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7853a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7854be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7855of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7856confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7857executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7858well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7859
7860@item jump *@var{address}
7861Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7862@end table
7863
c906108c 7864@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
7865On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7866command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7867difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7868changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7869example,
c906108c
SS
7870
7871@example
7872set $pc = 0x485
7873@end example
7874
7875@noindent
7876makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7877address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7878@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
7879
7880The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7881up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7882that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7883detail.
7884
c906108c 7885@c @group
6d2ebf8b 7886@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
7887@section Giving your program a signal
7888
7889@table @code
7890@kindex signal
7891@item signal @var{signal}
7892Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7893signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7894signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7895SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7896
7897Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7898giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7899a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7900@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7901signal.
7902
7903@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7904after executing the command.
7905@end table
7906@c @end group
7907
7908Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7909@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7910causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7911the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7912passes the signal directly to your program.
7913
c906108c 7914
6d2ebf8b 7915@node Returning
c906108c
SS
7916@section Returning from a function
7917
7918@table @code
7919@cindex returning from a function
7920@kindex return
7921@item return
7922@itemx return @var{expression}
7923You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7924command. If you give an
7925@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7926value.
7927@end table
7928
7929When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7930(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7931discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7932be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7933
7934This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7935frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7936innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7937specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7938of functions.
7939
7940The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7941program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7942returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7943and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7944selected stack frame returns naturally.
7945
6d2ebf8b 7946@node Calling
c906108c
SS
7947@section Calling program functions
7948
7949@cindex calling functions
7950@kindex call
7951@table @code
7952@item call @var{expr}
7953Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7954returned values.
7955@end table
7956
7957You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7958execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
7959with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7960is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 7961
c906108c
SS
7962For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7963specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7964calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7965method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7966that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 7967
6d2ebf8b 7968@node Patching
c906108c 7969@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 7970
c906108c
SS
7971@cindex patching binaries
7972@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 7973@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 7974
7a292a7a
SS
7975By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7976executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7977alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7978patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
7979
7980If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7981explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7982want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7983repairs.
7984
7985@table @code
7986@kindex set write
7987@item set write on
7988@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
7989If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7990core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
7991off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7992
7993If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
7994@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7995write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
7996
7997@item show write
7998@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
7999Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8000as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
8001@end table
8002
6d2ebf8b 8003@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
8004@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8005
7a292a7a
SS
8006@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8007both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8008program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8009@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
8010
8011@menu
8012* Files:: Commands to specify files
8013* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8014@end menu
8015
6d2ebf8b 8016@node Files
c906108c 8017@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 8018
7a292a7a 8019@cindex symbol table
c906108c 8020@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
8021
8022You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8023way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8024@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8025Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
8026
8027Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8028@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8029a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8030to specify new files are useful.
8031
8032@table @code
8033@cindex executable file
8034@kindex file
8035@item file @var{filename}
8036Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8037symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8038executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
8039directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8040@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8041directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8042to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8043and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8044
6d2ebf8b 8045On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
8046@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8047@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8048@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8049descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8050(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 8051@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 8052for more information.
c906108c
SS
8053
8054@item file
8055@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8056has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8057
8058@kindex exec-file
8059@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8060Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8061in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8062if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8063discard information on the executable file.
8064
8065@kindex symbol-file
8066@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8067Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8068searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8069table and program to run from the same file.
8070
8071@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8072program's symbol table.
8073
5d161b24 8074The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
8075of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8076auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8077the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8078the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8079
8080@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8081executing it once.
8082
8083When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8084understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8085generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8086other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
8087Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8088using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8089optimized code.
c906108c
SS
8090
8091For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8092using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8093symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8094quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8095details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8096
8097The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8098start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8099occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8100file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8101pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8102warnings and messages}.)
8103
c906108c
SS
8104We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8105symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8106symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8107still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8108in stabs format.
8109
8110@kindex readnow
8111@cindex reading symbols immediately
8112@cindex symbols, reading immediately
8113@kindex mapped
8114@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8115@cindex saving symbol table
8116@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8117@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8118You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8119tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8120load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 8121entire symbol table available.
c906108c 8122
c906108c
SS
8123If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8124@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8125cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8126file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8127from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8128than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8129program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8130starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8131
8132You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8133file has all the symbol information for your program.
8134
8135The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8136@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8137than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8138it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8139needed.
8140
8141The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8142@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8143symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
8144
8145@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8146@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8147@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8148@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8149@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8150@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8151@c files.
8152
8153@kindex core
8154@kindex core-file
8155@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8156Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8157of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8158address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8159executable file itself for other parts.
8160
8161@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8162to be used.
8163
8164Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8165under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8166wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8167the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8168(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8169
c906108c
SS
8170@kindex add-symbol-file
8171@cindex dynamic linking
8172@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8173@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
d167840f 8174@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
96a2c332
SS
8175The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8176information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8177when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8178into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8179address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8180this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8181of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8182section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8183@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8184
8185The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8186originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8187@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8188thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8189instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c
SS
8190
8191@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8192
8193You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8194the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8195table information for @var{filename}.
8196
8197@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8198@item add-shared-symbol-file
8199The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8200operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8201shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8202@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8203
c906108c
SS
8204@kindex section
8205@item section
5d161b24
DB
8206The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8207the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8208section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8209specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8210separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8211the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8212
8213@kindex info files
8214@kindex info target
8215@item info files
8216@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8217@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8218current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8219including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8220use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8221command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8222current ones.
8223
c906108c
SS
8224@end table
8225
8226All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8227as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8228name and remembers it that way.
8229
c906108c 8230@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8231@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8232libraries.
53a5351d 8233
c906108c
SS
8234@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8235when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8236(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8237references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8238debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8239
8240On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8241automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8242
c906108c
SS
8243@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8244@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8245@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8246
8247@table @code
8248@kindex info sharedlibrary
8249@kindex info share
8250@item info share
8251@itemx info sharedlibrary
8252Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8253
8254@kindex sharedlibrary
8255@kindex share
8256@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8257@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
8258Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8259Unix regular expression.
8260As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8261required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8262@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8263loaded.
8264@end table
8265
53a5351d
JM
8266On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8267and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8268a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8269
8270Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8271loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8272@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8273automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8274
8275To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8276
8277@table @code
8278@kindex set auto-solib-add
8279@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8280Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8281nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8282automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8283linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8284the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8285Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8286@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8287
8288@kindex show auto-solib-add
8289@item show auto-solib-add
8290Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8291@end table
c906108c 8292
6d2ebf8b 8293@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8294@section Errors reading symbol files
8295
8296While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8297such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8298output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8299they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8300debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8301about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8302only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8303times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8304to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8305complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8306messages}).
8307
8308The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8309
8310@table @code
8311@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8312
8313The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8314(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8315error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8316in its outer scope blocks.
8317
8318@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8319the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8320may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8321function.
8322
8323@item block at @var{address} out of order
8324
8325The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8326order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
8327do so.
8328
8329@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
8330locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
8331can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
8332@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8333messages}.)
8334
8335@item bad block start address patched
8336
8337The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
8338smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
8339to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
8340
8341@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
8342starting on the previous source line.
8343
8344@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
8345
8346@cindex foo
8347Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
8348larger than the size of the string table.
8349
8350@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
8351name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
8352with this name.
8353
8354@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
8355
7a292a7a
SS
8356The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
8357not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 8358uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 8359
7a292a7a
SS
8360@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
8361This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 8362are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
8363debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
8364on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
8365and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
8366
8367@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 8368
7a292a7a 8369@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 8370
7a292a7a 8371@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
c906108c 8372The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
8373information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
8374it.
c906108c
SS
8375
8376@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
8377
8378@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 8379
c906108c
SS
8380@end table
8381
6d2ebf8b 8382@node Targets
c906108c 8383@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 8384
c906108c
SS
8385@cindex debugging target
8386@kindex target
8387
8388A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
8389
8390Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8391in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8392you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
8393flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8394host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
8395realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8396command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8397(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
8398
8399@menu
8400* Active Targets:: Active targets
8401* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
8402* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8403* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 8404* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
8405
8406@end menu
8407
6d2ebf8b 8408@node Active Targets
c906108c 8409@section Active targets
7a292a7a 8410
c906108c
SS
8411@cindex stacking targets
8412@cindex active targets
8413@cindex multiple targets
8414
c906108c 8415There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
8416executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8417active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8418start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8419a core file.
c906108c
SS
8420
8421For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8422@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8423well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8424@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8425first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8426requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8427are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8428read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8429executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
8430
8431When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
8432target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8433commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8434an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8435process target is active.
c906108c 8436
7a292a7a
SS
8437Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8438core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 8439files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
8440the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8441process}).
c906108c 8442
6d2ebf8b 8443@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
8444@section Commands for managing targets
8445
8446@table @code
8447@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
8448Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8449process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8450facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8451protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
8452
8453Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8454typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8455with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
8456
8457The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8458after executing the command.
8459
8460@kindex help target
8461@item help target
8462Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8463currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8464(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8465
8466@item help target @var{name}
8467Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8468select it.
8469
8470@kindex set gnutarget
8471@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 8472@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8473knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
8474a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8475with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
8476with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8477
d4f3574e 8478@quotation
c906108c
SS
8479@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8480you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 8481@end quotation
c906108c 8482
d4f3574e
SS
8483@noindent
8484@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 8485
5d161b24 8486@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
8487@item show gnutarget
8488Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8489@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8490@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8491and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8492@end table
8493
c906108c
SS
8494Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8495configuration):
c906108c
SS
8496
8497@table @code
8498@kindex target exec
8499@item target exec @var{program}
8500An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8501@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8502
c906108c
SS
8503@kindex target core
8504@item target core @var{filename}
8505A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8506@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
8507
8508@kindex target remote
8509@item target remote @var{dev}
8510Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8511specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8512@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8513supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
8514some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8515it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8516
c906108c
SS
8517@kindex target sim
8518@item target sim
2df3850c 8519Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
8520In general,
8521@example
8522 target sim
8523 load
8524 run
8525@end example
d4f3574e 8526@noindent
104c1213 8527works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 8528drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
8529provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8530see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8531Processors}.
8532
c906108c
SS
8533@end table
8534
104c1213 8535Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
8536
8537@table @code
8538
c906108c
SS
8539@kindex target nrom
8540@item target nrom @var{dev}
8541NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8542
c906108c
SS
8543@end table
8544
5d161b24 8545Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 8546your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
8547
8548Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8549once you've successfully established a connection.
8550
8551@table @code
8552
8553@kindex load @var{filename}
8554@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
8555Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8556@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8557is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8558on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8559@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8560the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8561
8562If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8563execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8564target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
8565
8566The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8567For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8568link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8569specifies a fixed address.
8570@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8571
c906108c
SS
8572@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8573@end table
8574
6d2ebf8b 8575@node Byte Order
c906108c 8576@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 8577
c906108c
SS
8578@cindex choosing target byte order
8579@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
8580
8581Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8582offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8583orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8584designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8585which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 8586@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
8587
8588@table @code
8589@kindex set endian big
8590@item set endian big
8591Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8592
8593@kindex set endian little
8594@item set endian little
8595Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8596
8597@kindex set endian auto
8598@item set endian auto
8599Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8600executable.
8601
8602@item show endian
8603Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8604
8605@end table
8606
8607Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8608data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8609target system.
8610
6d2ebf8b 8611@node Remote
c906108c
SS
8612@section Remote debugging
8613@cindex remote debugging
8614
8615If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
8616@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8617For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
8618or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8619powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8620
8621Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8622to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 8623@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
8624but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8625write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8626communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8627
8628Other remote targets may be available in your
8629configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 8630
c906108c 8631@menu
c906108c 8632* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
8633@end menu
8634
6d2ebf8b 8635@node Remote Serial
104c1213 8636@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 8637
104c1213
JM
8638@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8639To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8640@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8641prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8642program, you need:
c906108c 8643
104c1213
JM
8644@enumerate
8645@item
8646A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8647have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8648your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 8649
5d161b24 8650@item
d4f3574e 8651A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 8652subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 8653
104c1213
JM
8654@item
8655A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8656download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8657manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8658documentation.
8659@end enumerate
96baa820 8660
104c1213
JM
8661The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8662communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8663machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 8664
104c1213
JM
8665@table @emph
8666@item On the host,
8667@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8668else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8669(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8670
8671@item On the target,
8672you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8673implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8674subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8675
8676On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8677@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8678@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8679@end table
96baa820 8680
104c1213
JM
8681The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8682machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8683@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 8684
104c1213
JM
8685@cindex remote serial stub list
8686These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 8687
104c1213
JM
8688@table @code
8689
8690@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 8691@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8692@cindex Intel
8693@cindex i386
8694For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8695
8696@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 8697@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8698@cindex Motorola 680x0
8699@cindex m680x0
8700For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8701
8702@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 8703@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8704@cindex Hitachi
8705@cindex SH
8706For Hitachi SH architectures.
8707
8708@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 8709@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8710@cindex Sparc
8711For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8712
8713@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 8714@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8715@cindex Fujitsu
8716@cindex SparcLite
8717For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8718
8719@end table
8720
8721The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8722recently added stubs.
8723
8724@menu
8725* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8726* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8727* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8728* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8729* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8730* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8731@end menu
8732
6d2ebf8b 8733@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
8734@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8735
8736@cindex remote serial stub
8737The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8738subroutines:
8739
8740@table @code
8741@item set_debug_traps
8742@kindex set_debug_traps
8743@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8744This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8745program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8746beginning of your program.
8747
8748@item handle_exception
8749@kindex handle_exception
8750@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8751This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8752explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8753run when a trap is triggered.
8754
8755@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8756execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8757with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8758protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 8759representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
8760information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8761retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8762execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8763@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 8764machine.
104c1213
JM
8765
8766@item breakpoint
8767@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8768Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8769breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8770way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8771machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8772pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8773@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8774simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8775again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8776your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 8777@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
8778
8779Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8780to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8781start of your debugging session.
8782@end table
8783
6d2ebf8b 8784@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
8785@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8786
8787@cindex remote stub, support routines
8788The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8789chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8790debugging target machine.
8791
8792First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8793serial port.
8794
8795@table @code
8796@item int getDebugChar()
8797@kindex getDebugChar
8798Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8799It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8800different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8801
8802@item void putDebugChar(int)
8803@kindex putDebugChar
8804Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 8805It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
8806different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8807@end table
8808
8809@cindex control C, and remote debugging
8810@cindex interrupting remote targets
8811If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8812running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8813for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8814character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8815remote system to stop.
8816
8817Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8818probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8819is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8820@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8821
8822Other routines you need to supply are:
8823
8824@table @code
8825@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8826@kindex exceptionHandler
8827Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8828handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8829way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8830are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8831containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8832@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8833its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8834might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8835exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8836@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8837and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8838you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8839should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8840
8841For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8842gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8843should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8844@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8845help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8846
8847@item void flush_i_cache()
8848@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 8849On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
8850instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8851instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8852
8853On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8854function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8855@end table
8856
8857@noindent
8858You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8859
8860@table @code
8861@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8862@kindex memset
8863This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8864memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8865@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8866either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8867@end table
8868
8869If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8870library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8871but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 8872subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
8873
8874
6d2ebf8b 8875@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
8876@subsubsection Putting it all together
8877
8878@cindex remote serial debugging summary
8879In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8880steps.
8881
8882@enumerate
8883@item
6d2ebf8b 8884Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
8885(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8886@display
8887@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8888@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8889@end display
8890
8891@item
8892Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8893
8894@example
8895set_debug_traps();
8896breakpoint();
8897@end example
8898
8899@item
8900For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8901@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8902
8903@example
8904void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8905@end example
8906
d4f3574e 8907@noindent
104c1213 8908but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 8909function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
8910@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8911error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8912one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8913
8914@item
8915Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8916your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8917
8918@item
8919Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8920the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8921
8922@item
8923@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8924@c document that. FIXME.
8925Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8926whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8927
8928@item
8929To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8930as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8931This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8932of its pure text.
8933
d4f3574e 8934@item
104c1213 8935@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8936Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
8937Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8938machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8939TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8940to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8941device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8942
8943@example
8944target remote /dev/ttyb
8945@end example
8946
8947@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8948To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8949@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8950terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8951
8952@example
8953target remote manyfarms:2828
8954@end example
8955@end enumerate
8956
8957Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8958step and continue the remote program.
8959
8960To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8961command.
8962
8963@cindex interrupting remote programs
8964@cindex remote programs, interrupting
8965Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8966interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8967program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8968and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8969interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8970
8971@example
8972Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8973Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8974@end example
8975
8976If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8977(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8978remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8979goes back to waiting.
8980
6d2ebf8b 8981@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
8982@subsubsection Communication protocol
8983
8984@cindex debugging stub, example
8985@cindex remote stub, example
8986@cindex stub example, remote debugging
8987The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8988communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8989@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8990these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8991implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8992with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8993organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8994
8995However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8996the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8997target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8998it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8999
9000In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9001transmitted and received data respectfully.
9002
9003@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9004@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9005@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
9006All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9007sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9008@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9009@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
9010
9011@example
9012@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9013@end example
9014@noindent
104c1213
JM
9015
9016@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9017@noindent
9018The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
9019characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9020eight bit unsigned checksum).
9021
9022Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9023specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9024
9025@example
9026@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9027@end example
104c1213
JM
9028
9029@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9030@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
9031That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9032has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9033since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 9034
6cf7e474 9035@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
9036When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9037response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9038the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9039retransmission):
9040
9041@example
9042<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9043-> @code{+}
9044@end example
9045@noindent
104c1213
JM
9046
9047The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9048debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9049the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9050when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9051
9052@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
9053exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9054exceptions).
9055
9056Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9057@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9058HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9059
9060Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9061@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9062would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
9063
9064Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 9065means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
9066which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9067@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
9068where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9069characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9070value greater than 126 should not be used.
9071
9072Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9073loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9074character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
9075
9076So:
9077@example
9078"@code{0* }"
9079@end example
9080@noindent
9081means the same as "0000".
9082
598ca718 9083The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
9084error number. That number is not well defined.
9085
9086For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9087(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9088protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 9089on that response.
104c1213 9090
f1251bdd
C
9091A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9092@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9093optional.
9094
104c1213
JM
9095Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9096their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 9097@page
104c1213
JM
9098@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9099@item Packet
9100@tab Request
9101@tab Description
9102
f1251bdd 9103@item extended ops
104c1213
JM
9104@tab @code{!}
9105@tab
d4f3574e 9106Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
598ca718 9107The extended remote protocol supports the @samp{R} packet.
104c1213
JM
9108@item
9109@tab reply @samp{}
9110@tab
9111Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
9112unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
9113support protocol extensions.
9114
9115@item last signal
9116@tab @code{?}
9117@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9118Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9119and continue.
9120@item
9121@tab reply
9122@tab see below
9123
104c1213
JM
9124
9125@item reserved
9126@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 9127@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9128
f1251bdd 9129@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9130@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9131@tab
598ca718
EZ
9132@item
9133@tab
9134@tab
104c1213
JM
9135Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9136specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 9137See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
9138@item
9139@tab reply @code{OK}
9140@item
9141@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9142
9143@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9144@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9145@tab
9146Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9147transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9148transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9149acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9150to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9151ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9152specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9153that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9154happened.}
9155
9156@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9157@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9158@tab
9159Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9160breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9161@samp{z} packets.}
9162
9163@item continue
9164@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9165@tab
9166@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9167current address.
9168@item
9169@tab reply
9170@tab see below
9171
f1251bdd 9172@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9173@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9174@tab
9175Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9176@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9177@item
9178@tab reply
9179@tab see below
9180
598ca718 9181@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9182@tab @code{d}
9183@tab
d4f3574e 9184toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9185
f1251bdd 9186@item detach
104c1213 9187@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9188@tab
2df3850c
JM
9189Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9190@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9191@item
9192@tab reply @emph{no response}
9193@tab
598ca718 9194@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9195
9196@item reserved
9197@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9198@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9199
9200@item reserved
9201@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9202@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9203
9204@item reserved
9205@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9206@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9207
9208@item reserved
9209@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9210@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9211
9212@item read registers
9213@tab @code{g}
9214@tab Read general registers.
9215@item
9216@tab reply @var{XX...}
9217@tab
9218Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9219with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9220each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9221determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9222@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9223@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
9224@item
9225@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9226@tab for an error.
9227
9228@item write regs
9229@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9230@tab
9231See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9232@item
9233@tab reply @code{OK}
9234@tab for success
9235@item
9236@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9237@tab for an error
9238
9239@item reserved
9240@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 9241@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9242
f1251bdd 9243@item set thread
104c1213
JM
9244@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9245@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9246Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9247@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9248continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9249thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
9250@item
9251@tab reply @code{OK}
9252@tab for success
9253@item
9254@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9255@tab for an error
9256
d4f3574e
SS
9257@c FIXME: JTC:
9258@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 9259@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
9260@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9261@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9262@c described. For example:
9263@c
9264@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9265@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9266@c otherwise returns current registers.
9267@c
9268@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9269@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9270@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9271
f1251bdd 9272@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9273@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9274@tab
9275Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9276present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9277step starting at that address.
9278
f1251bdd 9279@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9280@tab @code{I}
9281@tab
9282See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9283
9284@item reserved
9285@tab @code{j}
9286@tab Reserved for future use
9287
9288@item reserved
9289@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 9290@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9291
f1251bdd 9292@item kill request
104c1213
JM
9293@tab @code{k}
9294@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9295FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9296thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9297
9298@item reserved
9299@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 9300@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9301
9302@item reserved
9303@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 9304@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9305
9306@item read memory
9307@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9308@tab
9309Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9310Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9311using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9312transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9313@item
9314@tab reply @var{XX...}
9315@tab
d4f3574e 9316@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9317to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9318sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9319@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9320@item
9321@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9322@tab @var{NN} is errno
9323
9324@item write mem
9325@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9326@tab
9327Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9328@var{XX...} is the data.
9329@item
9330@tab reply @code{OK}
9331@tab for success
9332@item
9333@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9334@tab
9335for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
9336written).
9337
9338@item reserved
9339@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 9340@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9341
9342@item reserved
9343@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 9344@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9345
9346@item reserved
9347@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 9348@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9349
9350@item reserved
9351@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 9352@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9353
9354@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
9355@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
9356@tab
9357See write register.
9358@item
9359@tab return @var{r....}
9360@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
9361
f1251bdd 9362@item write reg
104c1213
JM
9363@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
9364@tab
9365Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
9366digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
9367@item
9368@tab reply @code{OK}
9369@tab for success
9370@item
9371@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9372@tab for an error
9373
f1251bdd 9374@item general query
104c1213
JM
9375@tab @code{q}@var{query}
9376@tab
598ca718 9377Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 9378have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
9379company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
9380optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
9381must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
9382@item
9383@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 9384@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
9385@item
9386@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9387@tab error reply
9388@item
9389@tab reply @samp{}
9390@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9391
f1251bdd 9392@item general set
104c1213
JM
9393@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9394@tab
9395Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9396naming conventions.
9397
598ca718 9398@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
9399@tab @code{r}
9400@tab
9401Reset the entire system.
104c1213 9402
f1251bdd 9403@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
9404@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9405@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9406Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9407definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9408packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213 9409
f1251bdd 9410@item step
104c1213
JM
9411@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9412@tab
9413@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9414same address.
9415@item
9416@tab reply
9417@tab see below
9418
f1251bdd 9419@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
9420@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9421@tab
9422Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9423@item
9424@tab reply
9425@tab see below
9426
f1251bdd 9427@item search
104c1213
JM
9428@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9429@tab
9430Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9431@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 9432bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 9433
f1251bdd 9434@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
9435@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9436@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9437@item
9438@tab reply @code{OK}
9439@tab thread is still alive
9440@item
9441@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9442@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 9443
104c1213
JM
9444@item reserved
9445@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 9446@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9447
9448@item reserved
9449@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 9450@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9451
9452@item reserved
9453@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 9454@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9455
9456@item reserved
9457@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 9458@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9459
9460@item reserved
9461@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 9462@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9463
9464@item reserved
9465@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 9466@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9467
9468@item reserved
9469@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 9470@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9471
f1251bdd 9472@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
9473@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9474@tab
9475@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
9476binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9477escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
9478@item
9479@tab reply @code{OK}
9480@tab for success
9481@item
9482@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9483@tab for an error
9484
9485@item reserved
9486@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 9487@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9488
9489@item reserved
9490@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 9491@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9492
f1251bdd 9493@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9494@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9495@tab
9496See @samp{Z}.
9497
f1251bdd 9498@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9499@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9500@tab
9501@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9502breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9503@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9504bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9505the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
9506@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9507potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 9508implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
9509@item
9510@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9511@tab for an error
9512@item
9513@tab reply @code{OK}
9514@tab for success
9515@item
9516@tab @samp{}
9517@tab If not supported.
9518
9519@item reserved
9520@tab <other>
5d161b24 9521@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9522
9523@end multitable
9524
d4f3574e
SS
9525The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9526receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9527@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9528when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9529number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9530conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
9531
9532@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9533
9534@item @code{S}@var{AA}
9535@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9536
9537@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9538@tab
9539@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9540(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9541by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9542thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 9543starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
9544@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9545extend the protocol.
9546
9547@item @code{W}@var{AA}
9548@tab
9549The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9550applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9551
9552@item @code{X}@var{AA}
9553@tab
9554The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9555
6d2ebf8b 9556@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 9557@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
9558@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
9559@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
9560@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
9561this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
9562spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
9563debugger.}
104c1213
JM
9564
9565@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9566@tab
c3f6f71d 9567@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
9568while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9569for 'W', 'T', etc.
9570
9571@end multitable
9572
d4f3574e
SS
9573The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9574
9575@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9576
9577@item current thread
9578@tab @code{q}@code{C}
9579@tab Return the current thread id.
9580@item
9581@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9582@tab
9583Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9584@item
9585@tab reply *
9586@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9587
bba2971c
MS
9588@item all thread ids
9589@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9590@item
9591@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 9592@tab
bba2971c
MS
9593Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
9594may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
9595works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
9596obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 9597be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 9598sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 9599@item
bba2971c
MS
9600@tab
9601@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 9602@item
5d161b24 9603@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
9604@tab A single thread id
9605@item
00e4a2e4 9606@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
9607@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
9608@item
9609@tab reply @code{l}
9610@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
9611@item
9612@tab
9613@tab
9614In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
9615or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
9616respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
9617@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
9618(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
9619
9620@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 9621@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
9622@tab
9623@item
9624@tab
9625@tab
9626Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
9627Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
9628the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
9629thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
9630The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 9631Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
9632"Blocked on Mutex".
9633@item
9634@tab reply @var{XX...}
9635@tab
9636Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
9637printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
9638attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
9639
9640@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9641@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9642@tab
2b628194
MS
9643@item
9644@tab
9645@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9646Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9647digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9648subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9649number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9650(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9651returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9652@item
bba2971c
MS
9653@tab
9654@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9655query (see above).
9656@item
d4f3574e
SS
9657@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9658@tab
2b628194
MS
9659@item
9660@tab
9661@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9662Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9663returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9664and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9665digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9666a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9667digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9668
bba2971c
MS
9669@item compute CRC of memory block
9670@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9671@tab
9672@item
9673@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9674@tab An error (such as memory fault)
9675@item
9676@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9677@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9678
d4f3574e
SS
9679@item query sect offs
9680@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
9681@tab
9682Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9683image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9684response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9685offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
9686@item
9687@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9688
9689@item thread info request
9690@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9691@tab
598ca718
EZ
9692@item
9693@tab
9694@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9695Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9696encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9697@item
9698@tab reply *
9699@tab
9700See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9701
9702@item remote command
9703@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9704@tab
598ca718
EZ
9705@item
9706@tab
9707@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9708@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9709execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9710Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9711number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9712packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9713stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9714@item
9715@tab reply @code{OK}
9716@tab
9717A command response with no output.
9718@item
9719@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9720@tab
9721A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9722@item
9723@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9724@tab
9725Indicate a badly formed request.
9726
9727@item
9728@tab reply @samp{}
9729@tab
9730When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9731
9732@end multitable
9733
9734The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9735In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9736bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9737space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9738The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9739least-significant.
9740
9741@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9742
9743@item MIPS32
9744@tab
9745All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
974632 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9747registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9748
9749@item MIPS64
9750@tab
9751All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9752thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9753as @code{MIPS32}.
9754
9755@end multitable
9756
104c1213
JM
9757Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9758does not get any direct output:
9759
9760@example
9761<- @code{R00}
9762-> @code{+}
9763@emph{target restarts}
9764<- @code{?}
9765-> @code{+}
9766-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9767<- @code{+}
9768@end example
9769
9770Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9771
9772@example
9773<- @code{G1445...}
9774-> @code{+}
9775<- @code{s}
9776-> @code{+}
9777@emph{time passes}
9778-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9779<- @code{+}
9780<- @code{g}
9781-> @code{+}
9782-> @code{1455...}
9783<- @code{+}
9784@end example
9785
6d2ebf8b 9786@node Server
104c1213
JM
9787@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9788
9789@kindex gdbserver
9790@cindex remote connection without stubs
9791@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9792allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9793@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9794
9795@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9796because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9797that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9798@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9799@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9800because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9801also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9802started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9803Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9804the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9805do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9806by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9807choice for debugging.
9808
9809@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9810or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9811protocol.
9812
9813@table @emph
9814@item On the target machine,
9815you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9816@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9817strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9818system does all the symbol handling.
9819
9820To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9821the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9822syntax is:
9823
9824@smallexample
9825target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9826@end smallexample
9827
9828@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9829hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9830@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9831@file{/dev/com1}:
9832
9833@smallexample
9834target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9835@end smallexample
9836
9837@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9838with it.
9839
9840To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9841
9842@smallexample
9843target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9844@end smallexample
9845
9846The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9847specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9848TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9849expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9850(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9851you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9852TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9853reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9854conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 9855and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
9856@code{target remote} command.
9857
9858@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9859you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9860symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9861using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9862(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9863running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9864remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9865is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9866@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9867@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9868
9869@smallexample
9870(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9871@end smallexample
9872
9873@noindent
9874communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9875
9876@smallexample
9877(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9878@end smallexample
9879
9880@noindent
9881communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9882For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9883the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9884text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9885@samp{Connection refused}.
9886@end table
9887
6d2ebf8b 9888@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
9889@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9890
9891@kindex gdbserve.nlm
9892@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9893allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9894@code{target remote}.
9895
9896@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9897using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9898
9899@table @emph
9900@item On the target machine,
9901you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9902@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9903can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9904host system does all the symbol handling.
9905
9906To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9907@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9908program. The syntax is:
9909
5d161b24 9910@smallexample
104c1213
JM
9911load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9912 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9913@end smallexample
9914
9915@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9916the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 9917to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
9918
9919For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 9920communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 9921using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
9922
9923@smallexample
9924load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9925@end smallexample
9926
9927@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9928you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9929symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9930using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9931(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9932running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9933remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9934argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9935@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9936
9937@smallexample
9938(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9939@end smallexample
9940
9941@noindent
9942communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9943@end table
9944
6d2ebf8b 9945@node KOD
104c1213
JM
9946@section Kernel Object Display
9947
9948@cindex kernel object display
9949@cindex kernel object
9950@cindex KOD
9951
9952Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9953@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9954and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9955mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9956displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9957
9958Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9959@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9960
9961@example
2df3850c 9962(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
9963@end example
9964
9965If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9966about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9967which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9968after the operating system:
9969
9970@example
2df3850c 9971(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
9972List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9973Object Description
9974any Any and all objects
9975@end example
9976
9977Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9978by the kernel.
9979
9980There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
9981is supported other than to try it.
9982
9983
6d2ebf8b 9984@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
9985@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9986
9987While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9988cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9989describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9990
9991There are three major categories of configurations: native
9992configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9993operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9994different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9995are quite different from each other.
9996
9997@menu
9998* Native::
9999* Embedded OS::
10000* Embedded Processors::
10001* Architectures::
10002@end menu
10003
6d2ebf8b 10004@node Native
104c1213
JM
10005@section Native
10006
10007This section describes details specific to particular native
10008configurations.
10009
10010@menu
10011* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10012* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10013@end menu
10014
6d2ebf8b 10015@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
10016@subsection HP-UX
10017
10018On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10019begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10020name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10021
6d2ebf8b 10022@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
10023@subsection SVR4 process information
10024
10025@kindex /proc
10026@cindex process image
10027
10028Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10029used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10030subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10031this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10032several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10033@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10034@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10035and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10036
10037@table @code
10038@kindex info proc
10039@item info proc
10040Summarize available information about the process.
10041
10042@kindex info proc mappings
10043@item info proc mappings
10044Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10045on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10046
10047@kindex info proc times
10048@item info proc times
10049Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10050its children.
10051
10052@kindex info proc id
10053@item info proc id
10054Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10055the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10056
10057@kindex info proc status
10058@item info proc status
10059General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10060stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10061received.
10062
10063@item info proc all
10064Show all the above information about the process.
10065@end table
10066
6d2ebf8b 10067@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
10068@section Embedded Operating Systems
10069
10070This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10071embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10072architectures.
10073
10074@menu
10075* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10076@end menu
10077
10078@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10079various real-time operating systems.
10080
6d2ebf8b 10081@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
10082@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10083
10084@cindex VxWorks
10085
10086@table @code
10087
10088@kindex target vxworks
10089@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10090A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10091is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10092
10093@end table
10094
10095On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10096current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10097
10098@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10099VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10100the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10101both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 10102@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 10103installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 10104@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
10105
10106@table @code
10107@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10108@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
10109All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10110This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10111seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10112your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
10113of a thin network line.
10114@end table
10115
10116The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10117this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10118procedures.
10119
10120@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10121To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10122to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10123library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10124VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10125kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10126source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10127information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10128manual.
10129@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10130
10131Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10132your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
10133run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10134@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
10135
10136@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10137
10138@example
10139(vxgdb)
10140@end example
10141
10142@menu
10143* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10144* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10145* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10146@end menu
10147
6d2ebf8b 10148@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
10149@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10150
10151The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10152network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10153
10154@example
10155(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10156@end example
10157
10158@need 750
10159@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10160
10161@smallexample
5d161b24 10162Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
10163Connected to tt.
10164@end smallexample
10165
10166@need 1000
10167@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10168loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10169these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10170path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10171to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10172
10173@example
10174prog.o: No such file or directory.
10175@end example
10176
10177When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10178the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10179command again.
10180
6d2ebf8b 10181@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
10182@subsubsection VxWorks download
10183
10184@cindex download to VxWorks
10185If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10186object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10187@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10188incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10189command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10190to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10191table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10192the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10193filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10194Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10195to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10196the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10197@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10198and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10199program, type this on VxWorks:
10200
10201@example
10202-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10203@end example
d4f3574e
SS
10204
10205@noindent
104c1213
JM
10206Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10207
10208@example
5d161b24 10209(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
10210(vxgdb) load prog.o
10211@end example
10212
10213@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10214
10215@smallexample
10216Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10217@end smallexample
10218
10219You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10220after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10221this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10222auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10223history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 10224debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
10225table.)
10226
6d2ebf8b 10227@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
10228@subsubsection Running tasks
10229
10230@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10231You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10232follows:
10233
10234@example
10235(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10236@end example
10237
10238@noindent
10239where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10240or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10241the time of attachment.
10242
6d2ebf8b 10243@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
10244@section Embedded Processors
10245
10246This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10247configurations.
10248
10249@menu
10250* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10251* ARM:: ARM
10252* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10253* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10254* i960:: Intel i960
10255* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10256* M68K:: Motorola M68K
10257* M88K:: Motorola M88K
10258* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10259* PA:: HP PA Embedded
10260* PowerPC: PowerPC
10261* SH:: Hitachi SH
10262* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10263* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10264* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10265* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10266@end menu
10267
6d2ebf8b 10268@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
10269@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10270
10271@menu
10272* A29K UDI::
10273* A29K EB29K::
10274* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10275* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10276* Remote Log:: Remote log
10277@end menu
10278
10279@table @code
10280
10281@kindex target adapt
10282@item target adapt @var{dev}
10283Adapt monitor for A29K.
10284
10285@kindex target amd-eb
10286@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10287@cindex AMD EB29K
10288Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10289@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10290@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10291name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10292@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10293
10294@end table
10295
6d2ebf8b 10296@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
10297@subsubsection A29K UDI
10298
10299@cindex UDI
10300@cindex AMD29K via UDI
10301
10302@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10303protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10304configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10305program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10306use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10307@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10308
10309@table @code
10310@item target udi @var{keyword}
10311@kindex udi
10312Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10313@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10314This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10315connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10316working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10317to its pathname.
10318@end table
10319
6d2ebf8b 10320@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
10321@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10322
10323@cindex EB29K board
10324@cindex running 29K programs
10325
10326AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10327with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10328term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10329@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10330must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10331board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10332assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10333@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10334
6d2ebf8b 10335@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
10336@subsubsection Communications setup
10337
10338The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10339in DOS on the PC:
10340
10341@example
10342C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10343@end example
10344
10345@noindent
10346This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10347bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10348you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10349end of the connection as well.
10350@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 10351@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10352@c
10353@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10354@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
10355@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10356@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10357@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
10358
10359To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10360the following at the DOS console:
10361
10362@example
10363C:\> CTTY com1
10364@end example
10365
10366@noindent
10367(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10368the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 10369had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
10370
10371From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10372@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10373
10374@example
10375cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10376@end example
10377
10378@noindent
10379The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10380serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10381may look something like the following:
10382
10383@example
10384tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10385@end example
10386
10387@noindent
10388Your system may require a different name where we show
10389@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
10390parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
10391@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
10392system table @file{/etc/remote}.
10393@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
10394@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
10395@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
10396@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
10397@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
10398@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
10399@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10400@c
10401@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
10402@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
10403@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
10404
10405@kindex EBMON
10406Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
10407directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
10408start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
10409with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
10410@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
10411@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
10412
10413@example
10414C:\> G:
10415
10416G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
10417
10418G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
10419Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
10420Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
10421Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
10422
10423Enter '?' or 'H' for help
10424
10425PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
10426I/O Base = 0x208
10427Memory Base = 0xd0000
10428
10429Data Memory Size = 2048KB
10430Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
10431Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
10432
10433PageSize = 0x400
10434Register Stack Size = 0x800
10435Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
10436
10437CPU PRL = 0x3
10438Am29027 Available = No
10439Byte Write Available = Yes
10440
10441# ~.
10442@end example
10443
10444Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10445typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
10446running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10447
10448For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10449way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 10450system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
10451PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10452something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10453other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10454from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10455serial line.
10456
6d2ebf8b 10457@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
10458@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10459
10460Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10461program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10462name of your 29K program:
10463
10464@example
10465cd /usr/joe/work29k
10466@value{GDBP} myfoo
10467@end example
10468
10469@need 500
10470Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10471
10472@example
10473target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10474@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10475@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10476@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10477@end example
10478
10479@noindent
10480In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10481@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10482@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10483In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10484a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10485the name on the Unix side.
10486
10487At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10488to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10489@code{run}.
10490
10491To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10492command.
10493
10494To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10495once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10496@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10497@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 10498Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
10499and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10500
6d2ebf8b 10501@node Remote Log
104c1213 10502@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 10503@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
10504@cindex log file for EB29K
10505
10506The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10507current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10508@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10509of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10510another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10511unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10512
6d2ebf8b 10513@node ARM
104c1213
JM
10514@subsection ARM
10515
10516@table @code
10517
10518@kindex target rdi
10519@item target rdi @var{dev}
10520ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10521use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10522monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 10523
104c1213
JM
10524@kindex target rdp
10525@item target rdp @var{dev}
10526ARM Demon monitor.
10527
10528@end table
10529
6d2ebf8b 10530@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
10531@subsection Hitachi H8/300
10532
10533@table @code
10534
d4f3574e 10535@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10536@item target hms @var{dev}
10537A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10538Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10539line and the communications speed used.
10540
d4f3574e 10541@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10542@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10543E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10544
d4f3574e
SS
10545@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10546@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 10547@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 10548@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
10549Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10550
10551@end table
10552
10553@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10554@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10555@cindex download to Hitachi SH
10556@cindex Hitachi SH download
10557When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10558board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10559board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10560@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10561
10562@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 10563Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
10564
10565@enumerate
10566@item
10567that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10568for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10569emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 10570the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
10571H8/300, or H8/500.)
10572
10573@item
10574what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10575serial device available on your host is the default).
10576
10577@item
10578what speed to use over the serial device.
10579@end enumerate
10580
10581@menu
10582* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10583* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10584* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10585@end menu
10586
6d2ebf8b 10587@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
10588@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10589
10590@c only for Unix hosts
10591@kindex device
10592@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 10593Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
10594need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10595first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10596hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10597
10598@kindex speed
10599@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 10600@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 10601speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 10602hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
10603the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10604@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
10605
10606The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10607use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10608use a DOS host,
10609@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10610called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10611through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10612to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10613
10614The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10615program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10616sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10617the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10618
10619First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10620board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10621port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10622When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 10623debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
10624for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10625@code{COM2}.
10626
10627@example
10628C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10629C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10630
10631Resident portion of MODE loaded
10632
10633COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10634
10635@end example
10636
10637@quotation
10638@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10639@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10640disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10641your development board.
10642@end quotation
10643
d4f3574e 10644@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
10645Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10646connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 10647the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
10648you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10649commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10650cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10651download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10652the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10653(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10654executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10655@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10656itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10657
10658@smallexample
10659(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 10660@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 10661 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 10662 the conditions.
5d161b24 10663There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 10664for details.
2df3850c
JM
10665@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10666(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 10667Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 10668(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
10669.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10670.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10671.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10672@end smallexample
10673
10674At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10675you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10676sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10677@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10678resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10679@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10680
10681Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10682available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10683you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10684
10685Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10686@itemize @bullet
10687@item
10688to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10689no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10690
10691@item
10692to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10693normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10694to detect program completion.
10695@end itemize
10696
10697In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10698development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10699
6d2ebf8b 10700@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
10701@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10702
d4f3574e 10703@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
10704You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10705Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10706e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10707
10708@table @code
10709@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10710Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10711@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10712@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10713(for example, @samp{9600}).
10714
10715@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10716If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10717specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10718@end table
10719
6d2ebf8b 10720@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
10721@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10722
10723Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10724
10725@table @code
10726
10727@kindex set machine
10728@kindex show machine
10729@item set machine h8300
10730@itemx set machine h8300h
10731Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10732architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10733to check which variant is currently in effect.
10734
10735@end table
10736
6d2ebf8b 10737@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
10738@subsection H8/500
10739
10740@table @code
10741
10742@kindex set memory @var{mod}
10743@cindex memory models, H8/500
10744@item set memory @var{mod}
10745@itemx show memory
10746Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10747@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10748memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10749@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10750
10751@end table
10752
6d2ebf8b 10753@node i960
104c1213
JM
10754@subsection Intel i960
10755
10756@table @code
10757
10758@kindex target mon960
10759@item target mon960 @var{dev}
10760MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10761
f0ca3dce 10762@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
10763@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10764An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10765the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10766@file{/dev/ttya}.
10767
10768@end table
10769
10770@cindex Nindy
10771@cindex i960
10772@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10773@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10774tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10775
10776@itemize @bullet
10777@item
10778Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10779Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10780
10781@item
10782By responding to a prompt on startup;
10783
10784@item
10785By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10786session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10787
104c1213
JM
10788@end itemize
10789
10790@cindex download to Nindy-960
10791With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10792downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10793@value{GDBN}.
10794
10795@menu
10796* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10797* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10798* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10799@end menu
10800
6d2ebf8b 10801@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
10802@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10803
10804If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10805options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10806reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10807
10808@example
5d161b24 10809Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
10810@end example
10811
10812@noindent
10813Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10814identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10815simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10816with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10817use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10818
6d2ebf8b 10819@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
10820@subsubsection Options for Nindy
10821
10822These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10823Nindy-960 board attached:
10824
10825@table @code
10826@item -r @var{port}
10827Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10828to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10829configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10830@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10831device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10832suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10833
10834@item -O
10835(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10836the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10837This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10838target architecture.
10839
10840@quotation
10841@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10842connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10843fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10844attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10845this process with an interrupt.
10846@end quotation
10847
10848@item -brk
10849Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10850system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10851
10852@quotation
10853@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10854requires; it only works with a few boards.
10855@end quotation
10856@end table
10857
10858The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10859port.
10860
10861@c @group
6d2ebf8b 10862@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
10863@subsubsection Nindy reset command
10864
10865@table @code
10866@item reset
10867@kindex reset
10868For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10869system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10870circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10871a break is detected.
10872@end table
10873@c @end group
10874
6d2ebf8b 10875@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
10876@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10877
10878@table @code
10879
10880@kindex target m32r
10881@item target m32r @var{dev}
10882Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10883
10884@end table
10885
6d2ebf8b 10886@node M68K
104c1213
JM
10887@subsection M68k
10888
10889The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10890target command for the following ROM monitors.
10891
10892@table @code
10893
10894@kindex target abug
10895@item target abug @var{dev}
10896ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10897
10898@kindex target cpu32bug
10899@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10900CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10901
10902@kindex target dbug
10903@item target dbug @var{dev}
10904dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10905
10906@kindex target est
10907@item target est @var{dev}
10908EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10909
10910@kindex target rom68k
10911@item target rom68k @var{dev}
10912ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10913
10914@end table
10915
10916If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10917instead have only a single special target command:
10918
10919@table @code
10920
10921@kindex target es1800
10922@item target es1800 @var{dev}
10923ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10924
10925@end table
10926
10927[context?]
10928
10929@table @code
10930
10931@kindex target rombug
10932@item target rombug @var{dev}
10933ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10934
10935@end table
10936
6d2ebf8b 10937@node M88K
104c1213
JM
10938@subsection M88K
10939
10940@table @code
10941
10942@kindex target bug
10943@item target bug @var{dev}
10944BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10945
10946@end table
10947
6d2ebf8b 10948@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
10949@subsection MIPS Embedded
10950
10951@cindex MIPS boards
10952@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10953MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10954you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10955
10956@need 1000
10957Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10958
10959@table @code
10960@item target mips @var{port}
10961@kindex target mips @var{port}
10962To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10963name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10964command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10965the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10966been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10967download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10968
10969For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10970port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10971debugger:
10972
10973@example
10974host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
10975@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10976(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10977(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10978(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
10979@end example
10980
10981@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10982On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10983connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10984concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10985@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10986
10987@item target pmon @var{port}
10988@kindex target pmon @var{port}
10989PMON ROM monitor.
10990
10991@item target ddb @var{port}
10992@kindex target ddb @var{port}
10993NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10994
10995@item target lsi @var{port}
10996@kindex target lsi @var{port}
10997LSI variant of PMON.
10998
10999@kindex target r3900
11000@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11001Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11002
11003@kindex target array
11004@item target array @var{dev}
11005Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11006
11007@end table
11008
11009
11010@noindent
11011@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11012
11013@table @code
11014@item set processor @var{args}
11015@itemx show processor
11016@kindex set processor @var{args}
11017@kindex show processor
11018Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11019processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 11020For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 11021to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 11022Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 11023is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 11024@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
11025
11026@item set mipsfpu double
11027@itemx set mipsfpu single
11028@itemx set mipsfpu none
11029@itemx show mipsfpu
11030@kindex set mipsfpu
11031@kindex show mipsfpu
11032@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11033@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11034If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11035coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 11036need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
11037file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11038functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11039@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11040functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11041with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11042processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11043double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11044@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11045
11046In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11047floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11048and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11049
11050As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11051@samp{show mipsfpu}.
11052
11053@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11054@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
11055@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11056@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
11057@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11058@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11059@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11060@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11061You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11062by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11063@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11064to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11065at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11066
11067@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11068@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11069@itemx show timeout
11070@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11071@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11072@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11073@kindex set timeout
11074@kindex show timeout
11075@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11076@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11077You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11078remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11079default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11080waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11081retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11082You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11083retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11084@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11085
11086The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11087is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11088forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11089to run before stopping.
11090@end table
11091
6d2ebf8b 11092@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11093@subsection PowerPC
11094
11095@table @code
11096
11097@kindex target dink32
11098@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11099DINK32 ROM monitor.
11100
11101@kindex target ppcbug
11102@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11103@kindex target ppcbug1
11104@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11105PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11106
11107@kindex target sds
11108@item target sds @var{dev}
11109SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11110
11111@end table
11112
6d2ebf8b 11113@node PA
104c1213
JM
11114@subsection HP PA Embedded
11115
11116@table @code
11117
11118@kindex target op50n
11119@item target op50n @var{dev}
11120OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11121
11122@kindex target w89k
11123@item target w89k @var{dev}
11124W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11125
11126@end table
11127
6d2ebf8b 11128@node SH
104c1213
JM
11129@subsection Hitachi SH
11130
11131@table @code
11132
d4f3574e 11133@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11134@item target hms @var{dev}
11135A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11136commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11137the communications speed used.
11138
d4f3574e 11139@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11140@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11141E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11142
d4f3574e
SS
11143@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11144@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
11145@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11146@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11147Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11148
11149@end table
11150
6d2ebf8b 11151@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11152@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11153
11154@cindex Sparclet
11155
5d161b24
DB
11156@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11157Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11158@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11159both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 11160@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11161
11162@table @code
f0ca3dce 11163@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 11164@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
11165@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11166This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11167seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11168@end table
11169
41afff9a 11170@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 11171When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 11172information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 11173load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 11174@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
11175
11176@example
11177sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11178@end example
11179
d4f3574e 11180You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
11181
11182@example
11183sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11184@end example
11185
41afff9a 11186@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11187Once you have set
11188your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 11189run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
11190(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11191
11192@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11193
11194@example
11195(gdbslet)
11196@end example
11197
11198@menu
11199* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11200* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11201* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 11202* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11203@end menu
11204
6d2ebf8b 11205@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
11206@subsubsection Setting file to debug
11207
11208The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11209
11210@example
11211(gdbslet) file prog
11212@end example
11213
11214@need 1000
11215@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11216@value{GDBN} locates
11217the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11218path.
11219If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11220files will be searched as well.
11221@value{GDBN} locates
11222the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11223path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11224If it fails
11225to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11226
11227@example
11228prog: No such file or directory.
11229@end example
11230
11231When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 11232the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
11233@code{target} command again.
11234
6d2ebf8b 11235@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
11236@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11237
11238The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11239To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11240
11241@example
11242(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11243Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 11244main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
11245@end example
11246
11247@need 750
11248@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11249
d4f3574e 11250@example
104c1213 11251Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 11252@end example
104c1213 11253
6d2ebf8b 11254@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
11255@subsubsection Sparclet download
11256
11257@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 11258Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
11259you can use the @value{GDBN}
11260@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11261The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11262command.
5d161b24 11263Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 11264address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
11265offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11266of each of the file's sections.
11267For instance, if the program
11268@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11269and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11270
11271@example
11272(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11273Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11274@end example
11275
5d161b24
DB
11276If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11277to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
11278to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11279
6d2ebf8b 11280@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
11281@subsubsection Running and debugging
11282
11283@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11284You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 11285commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
11286manual for the list of commands.
11287
11288@example
11289(gdbslet) b main
11290Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 11291(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
11292Starting program: prog
11293Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
112943 char *symarg = 0;
11295(gdbslet) step
112964 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 11297(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
11298@end example
11299
6d2ebf8b 11300@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
11301@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11302
11303@table @code
11304
11305@kindex target sparclite
11306@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
11307Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11308You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11309For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
11310remote protocol.
11311
11312@end table
11313
6d2ebf8b 11314@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
11315@subsection Tandem ST2000
11316
2df3850c 11317@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
11318STDBUG protocol.
11319
11320To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11321manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11322
11323@example
11324target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11325@end example
11326
11327@noindent
11328to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11329the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11330ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11331connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11332concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11333
11334The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11335this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11336would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11337(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11338available on your host computer.
11339@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11340@c basically hearsay.
11341
11342@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11343These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11344environment:
11345
11346@table @code
11347@item st2000 @var{command}
11348@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11349@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11350@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11351Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11352manual for available commands.
11353
11354@item connect
11355@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11356Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11357you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11358sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11359@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11360@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
11361@end table
11362
6d2ebf8b 11363@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
11364@subsection Zilog Z8000
11365
11366@cindex Z8000
11367@cindex simulator, Z8000
11368@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
11369
11370When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11371a Z8000 simulator.
11372
11373For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11374unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11375segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11376appropriate by inspecting the object code.
11377
11378@table @code
11379@item target sim @var{args}
11380@kindex sim
d4f3574e 11381@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
11382Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11383options, specify them via @var{args}.
11384@end table
11385
11386@noindent
11387After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11388CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11389@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11390to run your program, and so on.
11391
d4f3574e
SS
11392As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11393(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11394additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
11395
11396@table @code
11397
11398@item cycles
11399Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
11400
11401@item insts
11402Counts instructions run in the simulator.
11403
11404@item time
11405Execution time in 60ths of a second.
11406
11407@end table
11408
11409You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
11410conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
11411conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
11412simulated clock ticks.
11413
6d2ebf8b 11414@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
11415@section Architectures
11416
11417This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 11418all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
11419
11420@menu
11421* A29K::
11422* Alpha::
11423* MIPS::
11424@end menu
11425
6d2ebf8b 11426@node A29K
104c1213
JM
11427@subsection A29K
11428
11429@table @code
11430
11431@kindex set rstack_high_address
11432@cindex AMD 29K register stack
11433@cindex register stack, AMD29K
11434@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11435On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 11436@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
11437extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11438stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11439memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11440this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11441the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11442address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11443hexadecimal.
11444
11445@kindex show rstack_high_address
11446@item show rstack_high_address
11447Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11448processors.
11449
11450@end table
11451
6d2ebf8b 11452@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
11453@subsection Alpha
11454
11455See the following section.
11456
6d2ebf8b 11457@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
11458@subsection MIPS
11459
11460@cindex stack on Alpha
11461@cindex stack on MIPS
11462@cindex Alpha stack
11463@cindex MIPS stack
11464Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11465sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11466find the beginning of a function.
11467
11468@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11469To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11470@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11471you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11472commands:
11473
11474@table @code
00e4a2e4 11475@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
11476@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11477Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11478search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11479default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11480larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11481and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11482
11483@item show heuristic-fence-post
11484Display the current limit.
11485@end table
11486
11487@noindent
11488These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11489for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11490
11491
6d2ebf8b 11492@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
11493@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11494
53a5351d
JM
11495You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11496@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 11497data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 11498described here.
c906108c
SS
11499
11500@menu
11501* Prompt:: Prompt
11502* Editing:: Command editing
11503* History:: Command history
11504* Screen Size:: Screen size
11505* Numbers:: Numbers
11506* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 11507* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
11508@end menu
11509
6d2ebf8b 11510@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
11511@section Prompt
11512
11513@cindex prompt
11514
11515@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11516called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11517can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11518instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 11519the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
11520which one you are talking to.
11521
d4f3574e 11522@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
11523prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11524or a prompt that does not.
11525
11526@table @code
11527@kindex set prompt
11528@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11529Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11530
11531@kindex show prompt
11532@item show prompt
11533Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11534@end table
11535
6d2ebf8b 11536@node Editing
c906108c
SS
11537@section Command editing
11538@cindex readline
11539@cindex command line editing
11540
11541@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11542@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11543command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11544or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11545substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11546debugging sessions.
11547
11548You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11549command @code{set}.
11550
11551@table @code
11552@kindex set editing
11553@cindex editing
11554@item set editing
11555@itemx set editing on
11556Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11557
11558@item set editing off
11559Disable command line editing.
11560
11561@kindex show editing
11562@item show editing
11563Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11564@end table
11565
6d2ebf8b 11566@node History
c906108c
SS
11567@section Command history
11568
11569@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11570debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11571happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11572history facility.
11573
11574@table @code
11575@cindex history substitution
11576@cindex history file
11577@kindex set history filename
11578@kindex GDBHISTFILE
11579@item set history filename @var{fname}
11580Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11581This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11582list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11583exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11584the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11585to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
11586@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11587is not set.
c906108c
SS
11588
11589@cindex history save
11590@kindex set history save
11591@item set history save
11592@itemx set history save on
11593Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11594@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11595
11596@item set history save off
11597Stop recording command history in a file.
11598
11599@cindex history size
11600@kindex set history size
11601@item set history size @var{size}
11602Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11603This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11604@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11605@end table
11606
11607@cindex history expansion
11608History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11609@ifset have-readline-appendices
11610@xref{Event Designators}.
11611@end ifset
11612
11613Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11614is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11615@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11616follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11617a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11618history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11619@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11620
11621The commands to control history expansion are:
11622
11623@table @code
11624@kindex set history expansion
11625@item set history expansion on
11626@itemx set history expansion
11627Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11628
11629@item set history expansion off
11630Disable history expansion.
11631
11632The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11633editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11634or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11635@ifset have-readline-appendices
11636@xref{Command Line Editing}.
11637@end ifset
11638
11639@c @group
11640@kindex show history
11641@item show history
11642@itemx show history filename
11643@itemx show history save
11644@itemx show history size
11645@itemx show history expansion
11646These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11647@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11648@c @end group
11649@end table
11650
11651@table @code
41afff9a 11652@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
11653@item show commands
11654Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11655
11656@item show commands @var{n}
11657Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11658
11659@item show commands +
11660Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11661@end table
11662
6d2ebf8b 11663@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
11664@section Screen size
11665@cindex size of screen
11666@cindex pauses in output
11667
11668Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11669information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11670@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11671output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11672to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11673determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11674printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11675rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11676
d4f3574e
SS
11677Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11678driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 11679together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 11680@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
11681you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11682width} commands:
11683
11684@table @code
11685@kindex set height
11686@kindex set width
11687@kindex show width
11688@kindex show height
11689@item set height @var{lpp}
11690@itemx show height
11691@itemx set width @var{cpl}
11692@itemx show width
11693These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11694a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11695commands display the current settings.
11696
5d161b24
DB
11697If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11698output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
11699file or to an editor buffer.
11700
11701Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11702from wrapping its output.
11703@end table
11704
6d2ebf8b 11705@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
11706@section Numbers
11707@cindex number representation
11708@cindex entering numbers
11709
2df3850c
JM
11710You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11711@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11712@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11713begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11714default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11715numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11716change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11717radix} command.
c906108c
SS
11718
11719@table @code
11720@kindex set input-radix
11721@item set input-radix @var{base}
11722Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11723for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11724specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11725example, any of
11726
11727@smallexample
11728set radix 012
11729set radix 10.
11730set radix 0xa
11731@end smallexample
11732
11733@noindent
11734sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11735leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11736
11737@kindex set output-radix
11738@item set output-radix @var{base}
11739Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11740for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11741specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11742
11743@kindex show input-radix
11744@item show input-radix
11745Display the current default base for numeric input.
11746
11747@kindex show output-radix
11748@item show output-radix
11749Display the current default base for numeric display.
11750@end table
11751
6d2ebf8b 11752@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
11753@section Optional warnings and messages
11754
2df3850c
JM
11755By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11756running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11757command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11758internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
11759
11760Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11761which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11762see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11763
11764@table @code
11765@kindex set verbose
11766@item set verbose on
11767Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11768
11769@item set verbose off
11770Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11771
11772@kindex show verbose
11773@item show verbose
11774Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11775@end table
11776
2df3850c
JM
11777By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11778object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11779find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11780symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
11781
11782@table @code
2df3850c 11783
c906108c
SS
11784@kindex set complaints
11785@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
11786Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11787unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11788@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11789to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
11790
11791@kindex show complaints
11792@item show complaints
11793Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 11794
c906108c
SS
11795@end table
11796
11797By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11798lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11799you try to run a program which is already running:
11800
11801@example
11802(@value{GDBP}) run
11803The program being debugged has been started already.
11804Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11805@end example
11806
11807If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11808commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11809
11810@table @code
2df3850c 11811
c906108c
SS
11812@kindex set confirm
11813@cindex flinching
11814@cindex confirmation
11815@cindex stupid questions
11816@item set confirm off
11817Disables confirmation requests.
11818
11819@item set confirm on
11820Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11821
11822@kindex show confirm
11823@item show confirm
11824Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 11825
c906108c
SS
11826@end table
11827
6d2ebf8b 11828@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
11829@section Optional messages about internal happenings
11830@table @code
11831@kindex set debug arch
11832@item set debug arch
11833Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
11834@kindex show debug arch
11835@item show debug arch
11836Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
11837@kindex set debug event
11838@item set debug event
11839Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
11840default is off.
11841@kindex show debug event
11842@item show debug event
11843Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
11844info.
11845@kindex set debug expression
11846@item set debug expression
11847Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
11848default is off.
11849@kindex show debug expression
11850@item show debug expression
11851Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
11852debugging info.
11853@kindex set debug overload
11854@item set debug overload
11855Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C++ overload debugging
11856info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
11857is off.
11858@kindex show debug overload
11859@item show debug overload
11860Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C++ overload
11861debugging info.
11862@kindex set debug remote
11863@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
11864@cindex serial connections, debugging
11865@item set debug remote
11866Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
11867the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
11868@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
11869@kindex show debug remote
11870@item show debug remote
11871Displays the state of display of remote packets.
11872@kindex set debug serial
11873@item set debug serial
11874Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
11875default is off.
11876@kindex show debug serial
11877@item show debug serial
11878Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
11879info.
11880@kindex set debug target
11881@item set debug target
11882Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
11883includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
11884default is off.
11885@kindex show debug target
11886@item show debug target
11887Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
11888info.
11889@kindex set debug varobj
11890@item set debug varobj
11891Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
11892info. The default is off.
11893@kindex show debug varobj
11894@item show debug varobj
11895Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
11896debugging info.
11897@end table
11898
6d2ebf8b 11899@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
11900@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11901
11902Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
11903command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11904commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11905files.
c906108c
SS
11906
11907@menu
11908* Define:: User-defined commands
11909* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11910* Command Files:: Command files
11911* Output:: Commands for controlled output
11912@end menu
11913
6d2ebf8b 11914@node Define
c906108c
SS
11915@section User-defined commands
11916
11917@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
11918A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11919which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11920@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11921separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11922via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
11923
11924@smallexample
11925define adder
11926 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11927@end smallexample
11928
d4f3574e
SS
11929@noindent
11930To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
11931
11932@smallexample
11933adder 1 2 3
11934@end smallexample
11935
d4f3574e
SS
11936@noindent
11937This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 11938its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
11939reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11940functions calls.
11941
11942@table @code
2df3850c 11943
c906108c
SS
11944@kindex define
11945@item define @var{commandname}
11946Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11947by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11948
11949The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11950which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11951commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11952
11953@kindex if
11954@kindex else
11955@item if
11956Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11957It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11958only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11959There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11960by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11961was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11962
11963@kindex while
11964@item while
11965The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11966which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11967execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11968The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11969evaluates to true.
11970
11971@kindex document
11972@item document @var{commandname}
11973Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
11974accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11975defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11976reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11977After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
11978@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11979
11980You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11981documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11982does not change the documentation.
11983
11984@kindex help user-defined
11985@item help user-defined
11986List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11987(if any) for each.
11988
11989@kindex show user
11990@item show user
11991@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
11992Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11993not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 11994definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 11995
c906108c
SS
11996@end table
11997
11998When user-defined commands are executed, the
11999commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12000stops execution of the user-defined command.
12001
12002If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
12003without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12004commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
12005messages when used in a user-defined command.
12006
6d2ebf8b 12007@node Hooks
c906108c 12008@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
12009@cindex command hooks
12010@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 12011@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 12012
c78b4128
EZ
12013@kindex hook
12014@kindex hook-
12015You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
12016command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12017command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12018before that command.
12019
c78b4128
EZ
12020@cindex hooks, post-command
12021@kindex hookpost
12022@kindex hookpost-
12023A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12024Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12025@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12026that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12027pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12028
12029It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12030occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12031
12032@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12033@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12034
d4f3574e 12035@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
12036In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12037(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12038execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12039displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12040
c906108c
SS
12041For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12042single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12043you could define:
12044
12045@example
12046define hook-stop
12047handle SIGALRM nopass
12048end
12049
12050define hook-run
12051handle SIGALRM pass
12052end
12053
12054define hook-continue
12055handle SIGLARM pass
12056end
12057@end example
c906108c 12058
c78b4128
EZ
12059As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12060command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12061you could define:
12062
12063@example
12064define hook-echo
12065echo <<<---
12066end
12067
12068define hookpost-echo
12069echo --->>>\n
12070end
12071
12072(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12073<<<---Hello World--->>>
12074(@value{GDBP})
12075
12076@end example
12077
c906108c
SS
12078You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12079not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12080name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12081@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12082@c or not?
12083If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12084@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12085(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12086
12087If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12088get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12089
6d2ebf8b 12090@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
12091@section Command files
12092
12093@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
12094A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12095commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12096An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
12097the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12098
12099@cindex init file
12100@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 12101@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 12102When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
bf0184be
ND
12103@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
12104@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
12105following:
12106
12107@enumerate
12108@item
12109Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12110DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12111@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12112
12113@item
12114Processes command line options and operands.
12115
12116@item
12117Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12118
12119@item
12120Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12121@end enumerate
12122
12123The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12124complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12125and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12126option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12127
c906108c
SS
12128@cindex init file name
12129On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12130different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12131form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12132different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12133environments with special init file names:
12134
00e4a2e4 12135@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
12136@itemize @bullet
12137@item
00e4a2e4 12138VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12139
00e4a2e4 12140@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12141@item
00e4a2e4 12142OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12143
00e4a2e4 12144@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12145@item
00e4a2e4 12146ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12147@end itemize
c906108c
SS
12148
12149You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12150@code{source} command:
12151
12152@table @code
12153@kindex source
12154@item source @var{filename}
12155Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12156@end table
12157
12158The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12159printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12160of the command file.
12161
12162Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12163without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12164normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12165when called from command files.
12166
6d2ebf8b 12167@node Output
c906108c
SS
12168@section Commands for controlled output
12169
12170During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12171@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12172explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12173describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12174want.
12175
12176@table @code
12177@kindex echo
12178@item echo @var{text}
12179@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12180@c because it is not in ANSI.
12181Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12182@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12183newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12184In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12185by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12186string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 12187trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
12188To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12189@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12190
12191A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12192the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12193
12194@example
12195echo This is some text\n\
12196which is continued\n\
12197onto several lines.\n
12198@end example
12199
12200produces the same output as
12201
12202@example
12203echo This is some text\n
12204echo which is continued\n
12205echo onto several lines.\n
12206@end example
12207
12208@kindex output
12209@item output @var{expression}
12210Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12211newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 12212value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
12213on expressions.
12214
12215@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12216Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12217the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12218formats}, for more information.
12219
12220@kindex printf
12221@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12222Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12223@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12224either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12225@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12226subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
12227@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12228@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12229@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12230@c supported.
c906108c
SS
12231
12232@example
12233printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12234@end example
12235
12236For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12237
12238@smallexample
12239printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12240@end smallexample
12241
12242The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12243string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12244letter.
12245@end table
12246
6d2ebf8b 12247@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
12248@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12249
12250@cindex Emacs
12251@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12252A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12253edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12254@value{GDBN}.
12255
12256To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12257executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12258@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12259created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 12260@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
12261
12262Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12263things:
12264
12265@itemize @bullet
12266@item
12267All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12268@end itemize
12269
12270This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12271and output done by the program you are debugging.
12272
12273This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
12274commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
12275in this way.
12276
12277All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
12278with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
12279way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
12280stop.
12281
12282@itemize @bullet
12283@item
12284@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
12285@end itemize
12286
12287Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
12288source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
12289left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
12290source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
12291and the source.
12292
12293Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
12294usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
12295
12296@quotation
12297@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
12298current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
12299the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
12300appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
12301environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
12302session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
12303back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
12304avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
12305your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
12306@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
12307
12308A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
12309switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
12310@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
12311@end quotation
12312
12313By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
12314you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
12315several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
12316Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
12317
12318@example
12319(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
12320@end example
12321
12322@noindent
d4f3574e 12323(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
12324in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
12325``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
12326
12327In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
12328addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
12329
12330@table @kbd
12331@item C-h m
12332Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
12333
12334@item M-s
12335Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
12336update the display window to show the current file and location.
12337
12338@item M-n
12339Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
12340calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
12341to show the current file and location.
12342
12343@item M-i
12344Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
12345display window accordingly.
12346
12347@item M-x gdb-nexti
12348Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
12349display window accordingly.
12350
12351@item C-c C-f
12352Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
12353@code{finish} command.
12354
12355@item M-c
12356Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
12357command.
12358
12359@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
12360
12361@item M-u
12362Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
12363(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
12364like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
12365
12366@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
12367
12368@item M-d
12369Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
12370@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
12371
12372@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
12373
12374@item C-x &
12375Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
12376of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
12377around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
12378then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
12379argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
12380
12381You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
12382@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
12383otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
12384inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
12385wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
12386list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
12387formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
12388is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
12389@end table
12390
12391In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
12392tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
12393
12394If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
12395it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
12396request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
12397the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
12398frame.
12399
12400The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
12401which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
12402the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
12403communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
12404delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
12405to correspond properly with the code.
12406
12407@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
12408@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
12409@ignore
12410@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
12411@kindex Epoch
12412@kindex inspect
12413
5d161b24 12414Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
12415called the @code{epoch}
12416environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
12417@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
12418each value is printed in its own window.
12419@end ignore
c906108c 12420
d700128c 12421@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 12422@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 12423
6d2ebf8b 12424@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
12425@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
12426@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
12427@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
12428
12429Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
12430
12431Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
12432may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
12433the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
12434reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
12435
12436In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
12437information that enables us to fix the bug.
12438
12439@menu
12440* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
12441* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
12442@end menu
12443
6d2ebf8b 12444@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
12445@section Have you found a bug?
12446@cindex bug criteria
12447
12448If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
12449
12450@itemize @bullet
12451@cindex fatal signal
12452@cindex debugger crash
12453@cindex crash of debugger
12454@item
12455If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
12456@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
12457
12458@cindex error on valid input
12459@item
12460If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
12461bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
12462somewhere in the connection to the target.)
12463
12464@cindex invalid input
12465@item
12466If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
12467that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
12468``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
12469for traditional practice''.
12470
12471@item
12472If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
12473for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
12474@end itemize
12475
6d2ebf8b 12476@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
12477@section How to report bugs
12478@cindex bug reports
12479@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
12480
c906108c
SS
12481A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
12482If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
12483contact that organization first.
12484
12485You can find contact information for many support companies and
12486individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
12487distribution.
12488@c should add a web page ref...
12489
12490In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
12491@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
12492
12493@example
d4f3574e 12494bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
12495@end example
12496
12497@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 12498@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
12499not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
12500@samp{bug-gdb}.
12501
12502The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
12503serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
12504the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
12505newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
12506problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
12507path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
12508we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
12509bug reports to the mailing list.
12510
12511As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
12512
12513@example
12514@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
12515Free Software Foundation Inc.
1251659 Temple Place - Suite 330
12517Boston, MA 02111-1307
12518USA
12519@end example
c906108c
SS
12520
12521The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
12522@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
12523fact or leave it out, state it!
12524
12525Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
12526problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
12527assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
12528Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
12529stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
12530name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
12531of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
12532the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
12533easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
12534
12535Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
12536bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
12537you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
12538self-contained.
12539
12540Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
12541bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
12542@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
12543bugs properly.
12544
12545To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
12546
12547@itemize @bullet
12548@item
12549The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
12550with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
12551version}.
12552
12553Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
12554the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
12555
12556@item
12557The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
12558version number.
12559
c906108c
SS
12560@item
12561What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
12562``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
12563
12564@item
12565What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12566debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12567C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12568information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12569compilers.
12570
12571@item
12572The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12573observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12574you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12575Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12576
12577If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12578and then we might not encounter the bug.
12579
12580@item
12581A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12582reproduce the bug.
12583
12584@item
12585A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12586incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12587
12588Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12589will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12590not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12591a chance to make a mistake.
12592
12593Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12594say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12595copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12596the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12597crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12598ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12599us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12600to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12601
c906108c
SS
12602@item
12603If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12604diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12605it by context, not by line number.
12606
12607The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12608sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 12609
c906108c
SS
12610@end itemize
12611
12612Here are some things that are not necessary:
12613
12614@itemize @bullet
12615@item
12616A description of the envelope of the bug.
12617
12618Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12619which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12620changes will not affect it.
12621
12622This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12623will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12624with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12625We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12626
12627Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12628of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12629output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12630less time, and so on.
12631
12632However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12633report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12634
12635@item
12636A patch for the bug.
12637
12638A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12639the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12640a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12641to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12642
12643Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12644construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12645through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12646to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12647
12648And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12649patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12650help us to understand.
12651
12652@item
12653A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12654
12655Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12656things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12657@end itemize
12658
5d161b24 12659@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
12660@c and consists of the two following files:
12661@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12662@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12663@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12664@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12665@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12666@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12667
12668
6d2ebf8b 12669@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
12670@appendix Formatting Documentation
12671
12672@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12673@cindex reference card
12674The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12675for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12676subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12677@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12678release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12679you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12680
12681The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12682can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12683
12684@example
12685make refcard.dvi
12686@end example
12687
5d161b24
DB
12688The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12689mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
12690that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12691high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12692your @sc{dvi} output program.
12693
12694@cindex documentation
12695
12696All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12697distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12698a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12699on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12700formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12701and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12702
12703@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12704version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12705file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12706subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12707necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12708but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12709Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12710@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12711
12712If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12713Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12714@code{makeinfo}.
12715
12716If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12717@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12718version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12719
12720@example
12721cd gdb
12722make gdb.info
12723@end example
12724
12725If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12726a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12727Texinfo definitions file.
12728
12729@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12730produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12731document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12732has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12733command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12734(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12735require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12736
12737@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12738@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12739written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12740typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12741and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12742directory.
12743
12744If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12745typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12746subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12747@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12748
12749@example
12750make gdb.dvi
12751@end example
12752
12753Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 12754
6d2ebf8b 12755@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
12756@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12757@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12758@cindex installation
12759
c906108c
SS
12760@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12761of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12762build the @code{gdb} program.
12763@iftex
12764@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12765@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12766look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12767installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12768@end iftex
12769
5d161b24
DB
12770The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12771@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
12772appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12773
12774For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12775@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12776
12777@table @code
12778@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12779script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12780
12781@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12782the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12783
12784@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12785source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12786
12787@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12788@sc{gnu} include files
12789
12790@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12791source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12792
12793@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12794source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12795
12796@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12797source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12798
12799@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12800source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12801
12802@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12803source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12804@end table
12805
12806The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12807from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12808this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12809
12810First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12811if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12812identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12813argument.
12814
12815For example:
12816
12817@example
12818cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12819./configure @var{host}
12820make
12821@end example
12822
12823@noindent
12824where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12825@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12826(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12827correct value by examining your system.)
12828
12829Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12830@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12831libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12832binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12833
12834@need 750
12835@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12836system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12837shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12838
12839@example
12840sh configure @var{host}
12841@end example
12842
12843If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12844directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12845@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12846creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12847you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12848
12849You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12850subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12851configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12852
12853For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12854the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12855
12856@example
12857@group
12858cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12859../configure @var{host}
12860@end group
12861@end example
12862
12863You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12864However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12865the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12866that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12867let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12868
12869@menu
12870* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12871* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12872* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12873@end menu
12874
6d2ebf8b 12875@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
12876@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12877
12878If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12879you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12880host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12881allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12882rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12883handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12884@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12885program specified there.
12886
12887To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12888with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12889(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12890itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12891would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12892the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12893
5d161b24 12894For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
12895separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12896
12897@example
12898@group
12899cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12900mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12901cd ../gdb-sun4
12902../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12903make
12904@end group
12905@end example
12906
12907When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12908directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12909(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12910the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12911directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12912@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12913
12914One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
12915directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12916@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12917programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
12918You specify a cross-debugging target by
12919giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12920
12921When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12922it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12923called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12924
12925The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12926directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12927directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12928directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12929will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12930
12931When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12932directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12933if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12934with each other.
12935
6d2ebf8b 12936@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
12937@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12938
12939The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12940script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12941aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12942of information in the following pattern:
12943
12944@example
12945@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12946@end example
12947
12948For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12949or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12950option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12951
12952The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12953any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12954aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12955@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12956script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12957abbreviations---for example:
12958
12959@smallexample
12960% sh config.sub i386-linux
12961i386-pc-linux-gnu
12962% sh config.sub alpha-linux
12963alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12964% sh config.sub hp9k700
12965hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12966% sh config.sub sun4
12967sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12968% sh config.sub sun3
12969m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12970% sh config.sub i986v
12971Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12972@end smallexample
12973
12974@noindent
12975@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12976directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12977
6d2ebf8b 12978@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
12979@section @code{configure} options
12980
12981Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12982are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12983several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12984Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12985
12986@example
12987configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12988 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12989 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12990 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12991 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12992 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12993 @var{host}
12994@end example
12995
12996@noindent
12997You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12998@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12999@samp{--}.
13000
13001@table @code
13002@item --help
13003Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13004
13005@item --prefix=@var{dir}
13006Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13007@file{@var{dir}}.
13008
13009@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13010Configure the source to install programs under directory
13011@file{@var{dir}}.
13012
13013@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13014@need 2000
13015@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13016@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13017@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13018Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13019@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13020build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13021directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13022the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13023directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13024the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13025@var{dirname}.
13026
13027@item --norecursion
13028Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13029propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13030
13031@item --target=@var{target}
13032Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13033@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13034programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13035
13036There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13037
13038@item @var{host} @dots{}
13039Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13040
13041There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13042@end table
13043
13044There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13045needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 13046
6d2ebf8b 13047@node Index
c906108c
SS
13048@unnumbered Index
13049
13050@printindex cp
13051
13052@tex
13053% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
13054% meantime:
13055\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
13056\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
13057\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
13058\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
13059\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
13060\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
13061\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
13062\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
13063\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
13064\page\colophon
13065% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
13066@end tex
13067
449f3b6c
AC
13068@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
13069@ifinfo
c906108c 13070@contents
449f3b6c
AC
13071@end ifinfo
13072@ifhtml
13073@contents
13074@end ifhtml
13075
c906108c 13076@bye
This page took 0.655502 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.